blob: 790f8831d2dd24dbe6719bac1a47f7b381a6ceee [file] [log] [blame]
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner0bc735f2007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall2d887082010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregore737f502010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
17#include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbarc4a1dea2008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +000022#include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000023#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Narofff494b572008-05-29 21:12:08 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +000026#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000027#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000028#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000029#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000030#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000031#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
32#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
John McCall19510852010-08-20 18:27:03 +000033#include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
34#include "clang/Sema/Designator.h"
35#include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +000036#include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
John McCall19510852010-08-20 18:27:03 +000037#include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
John McCall7cd088e2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000038#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000039using namespace clang;
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +000040using namespace sema;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000041
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +000042
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000043/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
44/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
45///
46/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
47/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
48/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
49/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
50/// function is being used.
51///
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000052/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
53/// decls.
54///
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000055/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
56/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000057///
John McCall54abf7d2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000058bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Douglas Gregor9b623632010-10-12 23:32:35 +000059 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
60 // If there were any diagnostics suppressed by template argument deduction,
61 // emit them now.
62 llvm::DenseMap<Decl *, llvm::SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 1> >::iterator
63 Pos = SuppressedDiagnostics.find(D->getCanonicalDecl());
64 if (Pos != SuppressedDiagnostics.end()) {
65 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<PartialDiagnosticAt> &Suppressed = Pos->second;
66 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Suppressed.size(); I != N; ++I)
67 Diag(Suppressed[I].first, Suppressed[I].second);
68
69 // Clear out the list of suppressed diagnostics, so that we don't emit
70 // them again for this specialization. However, we don't remove this
71 // entry from the table, because we want to avoid ever emitting these
72 // diagnostics again.
73 Suppressed.clear();
74 }
75 }
76
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000077 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Benjamin Kramerce2d1862010-10-09 15:49:00 +000078 if (const DeprecatedAttr *DA = D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
79 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, DA->getMessage(), Loc);
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000080
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000081 // See if the decl is unavailable
Fariborz Jahanianc784dc12010-10-06 23:12:32 +000082 if (const UnavailableAttr *UA = D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
83 if (UA->getMessage().empty())
84 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
85 else
86 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable_message)
Benjamin Kramerce2d1862010-10-09 15:49:00 +000087 << D->getDeclName() << UA->getMessage();
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000088 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
89 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +000090
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000091 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000092 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000093 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
94 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
95 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
96 return true;
97 }
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000098 }
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000099
Anders Carlsson2127ecc2010-10-22 23:37:08 +0000100 // Warn if this is used but marked unused.
101 if (D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>())
102 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_used_but_marked_unused) << D->getDeclName();
103
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +0000104 return false;
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +0000105}
106
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000107/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000108/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000109/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
110///
111void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000112 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +0000113 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000114 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000115 return;
Douglas Gregor92e986e2010-04-22 16:44:27 +0000116
117 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
118 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000119 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
120 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000121
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +0000122 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
123 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000124 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000125 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
126 int isMethod = 0;
127 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
128 // skip over named parameters.
129 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
130 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
131 if (nullPos)
132 --nullPos;
133 else
134 ++i;
135 }
136 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
137 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000138 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000139 // skip over named parameters.
140 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
141 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
142 if (nullPos)
143 --nullPos;
144 else
145 ++i;
146 }
147 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000148 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000149 // block or function pointer call.
150 QualType Ty = V->getType();
151 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000152 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000153 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
154 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000155 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
156 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
157 unsigned k;
158 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
159 if (nullPos)
160 --nullPos;
161 else
162 ++i;
163 }
164 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
165 }
166 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
167 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000168 } else
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000169 return;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000170 } else
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000171 return;
172
173 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000174 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000175 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000176 return;
177 }
178 int sentinel = i;
179 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
180 --sentinelPos;
181 ++i;
182 }
183 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
184 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000185 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000186 return;
187 }
188 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
189 ++i;
190 ++sentinel;
191 }
192 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000193 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
194 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
195 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Anders Carlsson343e6ff2010-11-05 15:21:33 +0000196
197 // nullptr_t is always treated as null.
198 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isNullPtrType()) return;
199
Fariborz Jahanian9ccd7252010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000200 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000201 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
202 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
203 return;
204
205 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
206 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
207
208 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
209 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000210}
211
Douglas Gregor4b2d3f72009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000212SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
213 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
214 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
215}
216
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000217//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
218// Standard Promotions and Conversions
219//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
220
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000221/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
222void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
223 QualType Ty = E->getType();
224 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
225
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000226 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000227 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000228 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000229 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
230 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
231 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
232 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
233 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
234 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
235 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc39a3d72008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000236 //
237 // C++ 4.2p1:
238 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
239 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
240 //
241 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
242 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson112a0a82009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000243 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000244 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000245 }
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000246}
247
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000248void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
249 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000250
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000251 QualType Ty = E->getType();
252 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
253 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
254 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
255 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
256 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
257 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
258 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
259 // rvalue is T
260 //
261 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000262 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
263 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000264 // type of the lvalue.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000265 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CK_NoOp);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000266 }
267}
268
269
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000270/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000271/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000272/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
273/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
274/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
275Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
276 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
277 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000278
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000279 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
280 //
281 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
282 // unsigned int may be used:
283 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
284 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
285 // and unsigned int.
286 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
287 //
288 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
289 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
290 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
291 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000292 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
293 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000294 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000295 return Expr;
296 }
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000297 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000298 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000299 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000300 return Expr;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000301 }
302
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000303 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000304 return Expr;
305}
306
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000307/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000308/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000309/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
310void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
311 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
312 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000313
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000314 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000315 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
316 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000317 CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000318
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000319 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
320}
321
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000322/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
323/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
324/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
325/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000326bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
327 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000328 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000329
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000330 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
331 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
332 // etc.
333 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
334 return false;
335
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000336 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000337 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
338 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
339 << Expr->getType() << CT))
340 return true;
Douglas Gregor75b699a2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000341
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000342 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000343 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000344 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
345 << Expr->getType() << CT))
346 return true;
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000347
348 return false;
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000349}
350
351
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000352/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
353/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000354/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000355/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
356/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
357/// GCC.
358QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
359 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000360 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000361 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000362
363 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000364
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000365 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000366 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000367 QualType lhs =
368 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000369 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000370 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000371
372 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
373 if (lhs == rhs)
374 return lhs;
375
376 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
377 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
378 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
379 return lhs;
380
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000381 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000382 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000383 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
384 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000385 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000386 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
387 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
388
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000389 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000390 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000391 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
392 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000393 return destType;
394}
395
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000396//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
397// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
398//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
399
400
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000401/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000402/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
403/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
404/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
405/// string.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000406///
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000407ExprResult
Sean Hunt6cf75022010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000408Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000409 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
410
Chris Lattnerbbee00b2009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000411 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000412 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000413 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000414
415 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
416 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
417 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000418
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000419 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis55f4b022008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000420 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000421 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000422
423 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattner7dc480f2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000424 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000425 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000426
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000427 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
428 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
429 // strings.
430 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerdbb1ecc2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000431 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000432 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000433
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000434 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Sean Hunt6cf75022010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000435 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
436 Literal.GetStringLength(),
437 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
438 &StringTokLocs[0],
439 StringTokLocs.size()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000440}
441
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000442/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
443/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
444/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
445/// for values inside the block or for globals).
446///
Douglas Gregor076ceb02010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000447/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000448/// up-to-date.
449///
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000450static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000451 ValueDecl *VD) {
452 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
453 // we wanted to.
454 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
455 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000456
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000457 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
458 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
459 return false;
460
461 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
462 // snapshot it.
463 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
464 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000465 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
466 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000467
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000468 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
469 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
470
471 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
472 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
473 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
474 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000475 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
476 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000477
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000478 if (!NextBlock)
479 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000480
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000481 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
482 // having a reference outside it.
483 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
484 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000485
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000486 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
487 // a snapshot as well.
488 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
489 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000490
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000491 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000492}
493
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000494
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000495ExprResult
John McCalldbd872f2009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000496Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000497 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000498 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
499 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, NameInfo, SS);
500}
501
502/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000503ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000504Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty,
505 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
506 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000507 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000508 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000509 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000510 << D->getDeclName();
511 return ExprError();
512 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000513
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000514 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000515 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
516 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
517 // visible.
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +0000518 Ty = Ty.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000519 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000520 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
521 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000522 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
523 diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000524 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000525 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000526 << D->getIdentifier();
527 return ExprError();
528 }
529 }
530 }
531 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000532
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000533 MarkDeclarationReferenced(NameInfo.getLoc(), D);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000534
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000535 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
536 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
537 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000538 D, NameInfo, Ty));
Douglas Gregor1a49af92009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000539}
540
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000541/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
542/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
543/// actual member.
544///
545/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
546/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
547/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
548/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
549/// we found.
550///
551/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
552/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
553/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
554VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
555 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000556 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
557 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
558 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
559
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000560 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000561 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
562 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
563 do {
564 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCallbc365c52010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000565 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000566 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000567 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000568 else {
569 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
570 break;
571 }
572 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000573 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000574 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000575
576 return BaseObject;
577}
578
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000579ExprResult
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000580Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
581 FieldDecl *Field,
582 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
583 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
584 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000585 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000586 AnonFields);
587
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000588 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
589 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
590 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
591 // found via name lookup.
592 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000593 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000594 if (BaseObject) {
595 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
596 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000597 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000598 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Devang Patela2c21a22010-10-12 23:23:25 +0000599 Loc);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000600 BaseQuals
601 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000602 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
603 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
604 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
605 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
606 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000607 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000608 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
609 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
610 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000611 BaseQuals
612 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000613 } else {
614 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
615 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
616 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000617 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
618 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000619 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000620 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000621 = Context.getTagDeclType(
622 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
623 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000624 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000625 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
626 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
627 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor8aa5f402009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000628 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000629 MD->getThisType(Context),
630 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000631 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
632 }
633 } else {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000634 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
635 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000636 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000637 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000638 }
639
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000640 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000641 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
642 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000643 }
644
645 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
646 // anonymous struct/union.
647 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000648 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000649 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
650 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
651 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
652 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000653 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
654 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
655
656 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
657 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
658 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
659 ResultQuals.removeConst();
660
661 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
662 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
663
664 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
665 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
666
667 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
668 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
669 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
670
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000671 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000672 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000673 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000674 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
675 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000676 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000677 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000678 }
679
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000680 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000681}
682
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000683/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000684/// possibly a list of template arguments.
685///
686/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
687/// DecomposeTemplateName.
688///
689/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
690/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
691/// some way.
692static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
693 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
694 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000695 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000696 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
697 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
698 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
699 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
700
701 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
702 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
703 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
704 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
705 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
706
John McCall2b5289b2010-08-23 07:28:44 +0000707 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000708 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
709 NameInfo = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000710 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
711 } else {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000712 NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000713 TemplateArgs = 0;
714 }
715}
716
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000717/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
718/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
719/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000720static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000721 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
722 return false;
723
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000724 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
725 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
726 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
727 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
728 if (!BaseRT) return false;
729
730 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000731 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000732 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
733 return false;
734 }
735
736 return true;
737}
738
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000739/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
740/// the prospective base classes.
741static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
742 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
743 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000744 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000745 return false;
746
Douglas Gregor952b0172010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000747 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000748 if (!RD) return false;
749 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
750
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000751 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
752 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
753 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
754 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
755 if (!BaseRT) return false;
756
757 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000758 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
759 return false;
760 }
761
762 return true;
763}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000764
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000765enum IMAKind {
766 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
767 IMA_Static,
768
769 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
770 IMA_Mixed,
771
772 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
773 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
774 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
775
776 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
777 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
778 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
779
780 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
781 IMA_Instance,
782
783 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
784 IMA_Unresolved,
785
786 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
787 /// context is not an instance method.
788 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
789
790 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
791 /// non-class context.
792 IMA_AnonymousMember,
793
794 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
795 /// context is not an instance method.
796 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
797
798 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
799 /// class.
800 IMA_Error_Unrelated
801};
802
803/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
804/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
805/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
806/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
807/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
808/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
809static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
810 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000811 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000812
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000813 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000814 bool isStaticContext =
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000815 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
816 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000817
818 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
819 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
820
821 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
822 bool hasNonInstance = false;
823 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
824 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000825 NamedDecl *D = *I;
826 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000827 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
828
829 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
830 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
831 // that's a special case.
832 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
833 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
834 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
835 }
836 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
837 }
838 else
839 hasNonInstance = true;
840 }
841
842 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
843 // member reference.
844 if (Classes.empty())
845 return IMA_Static;
846
847 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
848 // an implicit member reference.
849 if (isStaticContext)
850 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
851
852 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
853 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
854 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
855 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000856 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000857 Classes))
858 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
859
860 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
861}
862
863/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
864static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
865 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
866 const LookupResult &R) {
867 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
868 SourceRange Range(Loc);
869 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
870
871 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
872 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
873 if (MD->isStatic()) {
874 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
875 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
876 << Range << R.getLookupName();
877 return;
878 }
879 }
880
881 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
882 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
883 return;
884 }
885
886 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000887}
888
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000889/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
890///
891/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000892bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
893 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000894 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
895
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000896 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000897 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000898 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
899 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000900 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000901 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000902 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
903 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000904
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000905 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
906 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
907 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
908 // dependent name.
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000909 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000910 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000911 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
912 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
913
914 if (!R.empty()) {
915 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
916 R.suppressDiagnostics();
917
918 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
919 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
920 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
921 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
922
923 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
924 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
925 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000926 if (isInstance) {
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000927 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
928 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000929 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000930 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000931 if (DepMethod) {
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000932 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
933 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
934 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
935 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(
936 R.getNameLoc(), DepThisType, false);
937 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
938 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
939 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
940 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
941 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
942 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
943 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL,
944 R.getLookupNameInfo(), &TList);
945 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000946 } else {
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000947 // FIXME: we should be able to handle this case too. It is correct
948 // to add this-> here. This is a workaround for PR7947.
949 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000950 }
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000951 } else {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000952 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000953 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000954
955 // Do we really want to note all of these?
956 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
957 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
958
959 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
960 return false;
961 }
Douglas Gregore26f0432010-08-09 22:38:14 +0000962
963 R.clear();
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000964 }
965 }
966
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000967 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000968 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbardc32cdf2010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000969 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000970 if (!R.empty()) {
971 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
972 if (SS.isEmpty())
973 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
974 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
975 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
976 else
977 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
978 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
979 << SS.getRange()
980 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
981 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
982 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
983 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
984 << ND->getDeclName();
985
986 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
987 return false;
988 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000989
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000990 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
991 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
992 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
993 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
994 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
995 // to recover well anyway.
996 if (SS.isEmpty())
997 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
998 else
999 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
1000 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
1001 << SS.getRange();
1002
1003 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
1004 return true;
1005 }
1006 } else {
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001007 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001008 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001009 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001010 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001011 else
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001012 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001013 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
1014 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001015 return true;
1016 }
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001017 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001018 }
1019
1020 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
1021 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
1022 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
1023 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1024 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
1025 << SS.getRange();
1026 return true;
1027 }
1028
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001029 // Give up, we can't recover.
1030 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1031 return true;
1032}
1033
Douglas Gregorca45da02010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001034ObjCPropertyDecl *Sema::canSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(IdentifierInfo *II) {
1035 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001036 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1037 if (!IDecl)
1038 return 0;
1039 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1040 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1041 return 0;
Douglas Gregorca45da02010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001042 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001043 if (!property)
1044 return 0;
1045 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
Douglas Gregorca45da02010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001046 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic ||
1047 PIDecl->getPropertyIvarDecl())
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001048 return 0;
1049 return property;
1050}
1051
Douglas Gregorca45da02010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001052bool Sema::canSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(ObjCPropertyDecl *Property) {
1053 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = getCurMethodDecl();
1054 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1055 if (!IDecl)
1056 return false;
1057 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1058 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1059 return false;
1060 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl
1061 = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(Property->getIdentifier()))
1062 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic ||
1063 PIDecl->getPropertyIvarDecl())
1064 return false;
1065
1066 return true;
1067}
1068
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001069static ObjCIvarDecl *SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001070 LookupResult &Lookup,
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001071 IdentifierInfo *II,
1072 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1073 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001074 bool LookForIvars;
1075 if (Lookup.empty())
1076 LookForIvars = true;
1077 else if (CurMeth->isClassMethod())
1078 LookForIvars = false;
1079 else
1080 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1081 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
1082 if (!LookForIvars)
1083 return 0;
1084
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001085 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1086 if (!IDecl)
1087 return 0;
1088 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
Fariborz Jahanian84ef4b22010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001089 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1090 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001091 bool DynamicImplSeen = false;
1092 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1093 if (!property)
1094 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanian43e1b462010-10-19 19:08:23 +00001095 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II)) {
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001096 DynamicImplSeen =
1097 (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic);
Fariborz Jahanian43e1b462010-10-19 19:08:23 +00001098 // property implementation has a designated ivar. No need to assume a new
1099 // one.
1100 if (!DynamicImplSeen && PIDecl->getPropertyIvarDecl())
1101 return 0;
1102 }
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001103 if (!DynamicImplSeen) {
Fariborz Jahanian84ef4b22010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001104 QualType PropType = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType(property->getType());
1105 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, ClassImpDecl,
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001106 NameLoc,
1107 II, PropType, /*Dinfo=*/0,
1108 ObjCIvarDecl::Protected,
1109 (Expr *)0, true);
1110 ClassImpDecl->addDecl(Ivar);
1111 IDecl->makeDeclVisibleInContext(Ivar, false);
1112 property->setPropertyIvarDecl(Ivar);
1113 return Ivar;
1114 }
1115 return 0;
1116}
1117
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001118ExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
John McCallfb97e752010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001119 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1120 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1121 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1122 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001123 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1124 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1125
1126 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor4c921ae2009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001127 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001128
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001129 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001130
1131 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001132 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001133 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001134 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001135
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001136 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
Douglas Gregor10c42622008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001137 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001138 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001139
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001140 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1141 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregor48026d22010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001142 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1143 // (note: handled after lookup)
1144 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1145 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1146 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001147 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1148 // names a dependent type.
1149 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1150 // we need to handle these differently.
Eli Friedman647c8b32010-08-06 23:41:47 +00001151 bool DependentID = false;
1152 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1153 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
1154 DependentID = true;
1155 } else if (SS.isSet()) {
1156 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
1157 if (DC) {
1158 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
1159 return ExprError();
1160 // FIXME: We should be checking whether DC is the current instantiation.
1161 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
1162 DependentID = !IsFullyFormedScope(*this, RD);
1163 } else {
1164 DependentID = true;
1165 }
1166 }
1167
1168 if (DependentID) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001169 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, NameInfo, isAddressOfOperand,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001170 TemplateArgs);
1171 }
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001172 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = false;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001173 // Perform the required lookup.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001174 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001175 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregord2235f62010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001176 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1177 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1178 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1179 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1180 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor1fd6d442010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001181 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1182 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1183 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001184 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001185 IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001186 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001187
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001188 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1189 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001190 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001191 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001192 if (E.isInvalid())
1193 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001194
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001195 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1196 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001197 // Synthesize ivars lazily
1198 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001199 if (SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, R, II, NameLoc))
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001200 return ActOnIdExpression(S, SS, Id, HasTrailingLParen,
1201 isAddressOfOperand);
1202 }
Fariborz Jahanianf759b4d2010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001203 // for further use, this must be set to false if in class method.
1204 IvarLookupFollowUp = getCurMethodDecl()->isInstanceMethod();
Steve Naroffe3e9add2008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001205 }
Chris Lattner8a934232008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001206 }
Douglas Gregorc71e28c2009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001207
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001208 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1209 return ExprError();
1210
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001211 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1212 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001213 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001214
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001215 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001216 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001217 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1218 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1219 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1220 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1221 }
1222
1223 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1224 // call, diagnose the problem.
1225 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor91f7ac72010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001226 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001227 return ExprError();
1228
1229 assert(!R.empty() &&
1230 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001231
1232 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1233 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001234 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001235 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1236 R.clear();
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001237 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001238 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1239 return move(E);
1240 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001241 }
1242 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001243
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001244 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1245 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1246
1247 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001248 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI && IvarLookupFollowUp &&
Fariborz Jahanianb1d58e32010-07-29 16:53:53 +00001249 !getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2 &&
1250 Var->isFileVarDecl()) {
Douglas Gregorca45da02010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001251 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property = canSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(II);
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001252 if (Property) {
1253 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_ivar_variable_conflict) << Var->getDeclName();
1254 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
Fariborz Jahanianf759b4d2010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001255 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_global_declared_at);
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001256 }
1257 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001258 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001259 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1260 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1261 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1262 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1263 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1264 // type.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001265 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001266 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001267
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001268 QualType T = Func->getType();
1269 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001270 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedman9a0fcfe2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001271 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1272 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001273 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001274 }
1275 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001276
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001277 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
John McCallfb97e752010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001278 // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3:
1279 // When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access
1280 // syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the
1281 // body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup
1282 // resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type
1283 // member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a
1284 // class member access expression using (*this) as the
1285 // postfix-expression to the left of the . operator.
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001286 //
1287 // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R
1288 // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the
1289 // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a
1290 // non-static member function:
1291 //
1292 // C++ [expr.ref]p4:
1293 // Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . .
1294 // [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a
1295 // member function call.
1296 //
1297 // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important
1298 // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a
1299 // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent
1300 // instance method.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001301 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001302 bool MightBeImplicitMember;
1303 if (!isAddressOfOperand)
1304 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
1305 else if (!SS.isEmpty())
1306 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
1307 else if (R.isOverloadedResult())
1308 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
Douglas Gregore2248be2010-08-30 16:00:47 +00001309 else if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
1310 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001311 else
1312 MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl());
1313
1314 if (MightBeImplicitMember)
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001315 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001316 }
1317
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001318 if (TemplateArgs)
1319 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001320
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001321 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1322}
1323
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001324/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001325ExprResult
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001326Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1327 LookupResult &R,
1328 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1329 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1330 case IMA_Instance:
1331 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1332
1333 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1334 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1335 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1336 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1337
1338 case IMA_Mixed:
1339 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1340 case IMA_Unresolved:
1341 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1342
1343 case IMA_Static:
1344 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1345 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1346 if (TemplateArgs)
1347 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1348 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1349
1350 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1351 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1352 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1353 return ExprError();
1354 }
1355
1356 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1357 return ExprError();
1358}
1359
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001360/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1361/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1362/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1363/// this path.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001364ExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001365Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001366 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001367 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001368 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001369 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, NameInfo, 0);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001370
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001371 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001372 return ExprError();
1373
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001374 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001375 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1376
1377 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1378 return ExprError();
1379
1380 if (R.empty()) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001381 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1382 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001383 return ExprError();
1384 }
1385
1386 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1387}
1388
1389/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1390/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1391/// additional lookup.
1392///
1393/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1394/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1395///
1396/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001397ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001398Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnereb483eb2010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001399 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001400 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001401 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001402
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001403 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1404 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1405 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1406 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1407 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1408
1409 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1410 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1411 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001412 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001413
1414 bool LookForIvars;
1415 if (Lookup.empty())
1416 LookForIvars = true;
1417 else if (IsClassMethod)
1418 LookForIvars = false;
1419 else
1420 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1421 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian412e7982010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001422 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001423 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001424 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001425 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1426 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1427 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1428 if (IsClassMethod)
1429 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1430 << IV->getDeclName());
1431
1432 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1433 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1434 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1435 return ExprError();
1436
1437 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1438 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1439 return ExprError();
1440
1441 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1442 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1443 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1444 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1445
1446 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1447 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1448 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1449 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001450 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001451 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001452 ExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
Douglas Gregore45bb6a2010-09-22 16:33:13 +00001453 SelfName, false, false);
1454 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid())
1455 return ExprError();
1456
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001457 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1458 return Owned(new (Context)
1459 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1460 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1461 }
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001462 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001463 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001464 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001465 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1466 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1467 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1468 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1469 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1470 }
1471 }
1472
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001473 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1474 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1475 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1476 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1477 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1478 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1479 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1480 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1481 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1482 }
1483 }
1484 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001485 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1486 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001487}
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001488
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001489/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1490///
1491/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1492///
1493/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1494/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1495/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1496/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1497///
1498/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1499/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1500/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1501/// the class declaring the member.
1502///
1503/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1504/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1505/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001506bool
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001507Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1508 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001509 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001510 NamedDecl *Member) {
1511 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1512 if (!RD)
1513 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001514
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001515 QualType DestRecordType;
1516 QualType DestType;
1517 QualType FromRecordType;
1518 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1519 bool PointerConversions = false;
1520 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1521 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001522
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001523 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1524 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1525 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1526 PointerConversions = true;
1527 } else {
1528 DestType = DestRecordType;
1529 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001530 }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001531 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1532 if (Method->isStatic())
1533 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001534
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001535 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1536 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001537
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001538 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1539 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1540 PointerConversions = true;
1541 } else {
1542 FromRecordType = FromType;
1543 DestType = DestRecordType;
1544 }
1545 } else {
1546 // No conversion necessary.
1547 return false;
1548 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001549
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001550 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1551 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001552
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001553 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1554 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1555 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001556
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001557 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1558 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1559
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001560 ExprValueKind VK = CastCategory(From);
Sebastian Redl906082e2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001561
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001562 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001563 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001564 // class name.
1565 //
1566 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1567 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1568 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1569 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1570 //
1571 // class Base { public: int x; };
1572 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1573 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1574 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1575 //
1576 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1577 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1578 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1579 // }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001580 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001581 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1582 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1583 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1584
1585 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1586
1587 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1588 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1589 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1590 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001591 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001592 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001593 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001594 return true;
1595
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001596 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001597 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001598 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
1599 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001600
1601 FromType = QType;
1602 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1603
1604 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1605 // we're done.
1606 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1607 return false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001608 }
1609 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001610
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001611 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001612
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001613 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1614 // down to the using declaration's type.
1615 //
1616 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1617 // class ever has member declarations.
1618 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1619 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1620 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1621 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1622
1623 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1624 // conversion is non-trivial.
1625 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1626 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001627 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001628 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001629 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001630 return true;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001631
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001632 QualType UType = URecordType;
1633 if (PointerConversions)
1634 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001635 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001636 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001637 FromType = UType;
1638 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1639 }
1640
1641 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1642 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1643 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001644 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001645
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001646 CXXCastPath BasePath;
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001647 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1648 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001649 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001650 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001651
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001652 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001653 VK, &BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001654 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001655}
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001656
Douglas Gregor83f6faf2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001657/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001658static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedmanf595cc42009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001659 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001660 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001661 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo,
1662 QualType Ty,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001663 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1664 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1665 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001666 if (SS.isSet()) {
1667 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1668 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001669 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001670
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001671 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001672 Member, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
1673 TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001674}
1675
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001676/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1677/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1678/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1679/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001680ExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001681Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1682 LookupResult &R,
1683 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1684 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001685 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1686
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001687 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001688
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001689 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1690 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregore961afb2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001691 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001692 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001693 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001694 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001695 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001696
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001697 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1698 // 'this' expression now.
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001699 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1700 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001701 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1702 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001703 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1704 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1705 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1706 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001707 }
1708
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001709 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(This, ThisType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001710 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1711 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001712 SS,
1713 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1714 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001715}
1716
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001717bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001718 const LookupResult &R,
1719 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001720 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1721 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1722 return false;
1723
1724 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001725 if (SS.isSet())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001726 return false;
1727
1728 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001729 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001730 return false;
1731
1732 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1733 // normal lookup:
1734 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1735 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1736
1737 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1738 // -- a declaration of a class member
1739 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1740 // original decl.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001741 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001742 return false;
1743
1744 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1745 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1746 // using-declaration
1747 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1748 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1749 // turn off ADL anyway).
1750 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1751 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1752 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1753 return false;
1754
1755 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1756 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1757 // template
1758 // And also for builtin functions.
1759 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1760 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1761
1762 // But also builtin functions.
1763 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1764 return false;
1765 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1766 return false;
1767 }
1768
1769 return true;
1770}
1771
1772
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001773/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1774/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1775/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1776/// will in fact be used.
1777static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1778 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1779 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1780 return true;
1781 }
1782
1783 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1784 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1785 return true;
1786 }
1787
1788 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1789 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1790 return true;
1791 }
1792
1793 return false;
1794}
1795
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001796ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001797Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001798 LookupResult &R,
1799 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCallfead20c2009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001800 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1801 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor86b8e092010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001802 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001803 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(),
1804 R.getFoundDecl());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001805
1806 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1807 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1808 // functions and function templates.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001809 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1810 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001811 return ExprError();
1812
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001813 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1814 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1815 // we've picked a target.
1816 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1817
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001818 bool Dependent
1819 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001820 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001821 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001822 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001823 SS.getRange(), R.getLookupNameInfo(),
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001824 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1825 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001826
1827 return Owned(ULE);
1828}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001829
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001830
1831/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001832ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001833Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001834 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
1835 NamedDecl *D) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001836 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall7453ed42009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001837 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1838 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001839
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001840 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001841 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1842 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001843
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001844 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1845 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1846 // a template argument list.
1847 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1848 << Template << SS.getRange();
1849 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1850 return ExprError();
1851 }
1852
1853 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1854 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1855 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001856 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001857 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCall87cf6702009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001858 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001859 return ExprError();
1860 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001861
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001862 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1863 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1864 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1865 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001866 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001867 return ExprError();
1868
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001869 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1870 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001871 return ExprError();
1872
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001873 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1874 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1875 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1876 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001877 //
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001878 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1879 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1880 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001881 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001882 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump0d6fd572010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001883 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1884 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1885 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1886 return ExprError();
1887 }
1888
Fariborz Jahanian8596bbe2010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001889 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump28497342010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001890 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1891 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1892 return ExprError();
1893 }
1894
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001895 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001896 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001897 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001898 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001899 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001900 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1901 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001902 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001903
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001904 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian52bc56a2010-07-12 17:26:57 +00001905 QualType T = VD->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001906 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1907 ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanian84ca0082010-07-12 18:12:03 +00001908 constAdded);
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001909 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1910 if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isReferenceType()) {
1911 Expr *E = new (Context)
1912 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1913 SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001914
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001915 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001916 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
Fariborz Jahanian310b1c42010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001917 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001918 SourceLocation(),
1919 Owned(E));
1920 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001921 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(Res.get());
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001922 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
1923 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
1924 }
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001925 }
1926 }
1927 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001928 }
1929 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1930 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001931
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001932 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
1933 NameInfo, &SS);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001934}
1935
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001936ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001937 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001938 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001939
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001940 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001941 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001942 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1943 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1944 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001945 }
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001946
Chris Lattnerfa28b302008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001947 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1948 // string.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001949
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001950 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanianeb024ac2010-07-23 21:53:24 +00001951 if (!currentDecl && getCurBlock())
1952 currentDecl = getCurBlock()->TheDecl;
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001953 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001954 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001955 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001956 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001957
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001958 QualType ResTy;
1959 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1960 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1961 } else {
Anders Carlsson848fa642010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001962 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001963
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001964 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001965 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001966 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1967 }
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001968 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001969}
1970
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001971ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001972 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001973 bool Invalid = false;
1974 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1975 if (Invalid)
1976 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001977
Benjamin Kramerddeea562010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001978 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1979 PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001980 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001981 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001982
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001983 QualType Ty;
1984 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1985 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1986 else if (Literal.isWide())
1987 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedman136b0cd2010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001988 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1989 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001990 else
1991 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001992
Sebastian Redle91b3bc2009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001993 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1994 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001995 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001996}
1997
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001998ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001999 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002000 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
2001 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner7216dc92009-01-26 22:36:52 +00002002 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattner0c21e842009-01-16 07:10:29 +00002003 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002004 return Owned(IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff0a473932009-01-20 19:53:53 +00002005 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002006 }
Ted Kremenek28396602009-01-13 23:19:12 +00002007
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002008 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattner2a299042008-09-30 20:53:45 +00002009 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
2010 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002011 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002012
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002013 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00002014 bool Invalid = false;
2015 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
2016 if (Invalid)
2017 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002018
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002019 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002020 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
2021 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002022 return ExprError();
2023
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002024 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002025
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002026 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002027 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002028 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002029 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002030 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002031 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002032 else
Chris Lattner9e9b6dc2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00002033 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002034
2035 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
2036
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002037 using llvm::APFloat;
2038 APFloat Val(Format);
2039
2040 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall9f2df882009-12-24 11:09:08 +00002041
2042 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
2043 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
2044 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
2045 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002046 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002047 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002048 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002049 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002050 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
2051 } else {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002052 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002053 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
2054 }
2055
2056 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
2057 << Ty
2058 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
2059 }
2060
2061 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002062 Res = FloatingLiteral::Create(Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002063
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002064 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002065 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002066 } else {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002067 QualType Ty;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002068
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002069 // long long is a C99 feature.
2070 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth79859c32007-08-29 22:13:52 +00002071 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002072 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
2073
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002074 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002075 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002076
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002077 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
2078 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
2079 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002080 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
2081 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002082 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002083 } else {
2084 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
2085 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002086
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002087 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
2088 // be an unsigned int.
2089 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
2090
2091 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002092 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner97c51562007-08-23 21:58:08 +00002093 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
2094 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002095 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002096
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002097 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
2098 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
2099 // Does it fit in a signed int?
2100 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002101 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002102 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002103 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002104 Width = IntSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002105 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002106 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002107
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002108 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002109 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002110 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002111
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002112 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
2113 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
2114 // Does it fit in a signed long?
2115 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002116 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002117 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002118 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002119 Width = LongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002120 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002121 }
2122
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002123 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002124 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002125 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002126
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002127 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
2128 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
2129 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
2130 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002131 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002132 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002133 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002134 Width = LongLongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002135 }
2136 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002137
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002138 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
2139 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002140 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002141 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002142 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002143 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002144 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002145
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002146 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
2147 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002148 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002149 Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002150 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002151
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002152 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2153 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002154 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002155 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002156
2157 return Owned(Res);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002158}
2159
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002160ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002161 SourceLocation R, Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002162 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002163 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002164}
2165
2166/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
2167/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002168bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002169 SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002170 SourceRange ExprRange,
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002171 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002172 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2173 return false;
2174
Sebastian Redl5d484e82009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002175 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2176 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2177 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2178 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2179 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2180 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2181
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002182 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002183 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002184 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002185 if (isSizeof)
2186 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2187 return false;
2188 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002189
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002190 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002191 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002192 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2193 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002194 return false;
2195 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002196
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002197 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002198 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2199 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002200 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002201
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002202 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002203 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002204 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattner5cb10d32009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002205 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2206 return true;
Chris Lattnerca790922009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002207 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002208
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002209 return false;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002210}
2211
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002212static bool CheckAlignOfExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2213 SourceRange ExprRange) {
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002214 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002215
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002216 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002217 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2218 return false;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002219
2220 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2221 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2222 return false;
2223
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002224 if (E->getBitField()) {
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002225 S. Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002226 return true;
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002227 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002228
2229 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2230 // bit-field.
2231 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump8e1fab22009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002232 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002233 return false;
2234
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002235 return S.CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002236}
2237
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002238/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002239ExprResult
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002240Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002241 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002242 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002243 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002244 return ExprError();
2245
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002246 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002247
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002248 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2249 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2250 return ExprError();
2251
2252 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002253 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002254 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2255 R.getEnd()));
2256}
2257
2258/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2259/// operand.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002260ExprResult
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002261Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002262 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2263 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2264 bool isInvalid = false;
2265 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2266 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2267 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002268 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(*this, E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002269 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002270 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2271 isInvalid = true;
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00002272 } else if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) {
2273 ExprResult PE = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E, OpLoc);
2274 if (PE.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2275 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(PE.take(), OpLoc, isSizeOf, R);
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002276 } else {
2277 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2278 }
2279
2280 if (isInvalid)
2281 return ExprError();
2282
2283 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2284 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2285 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2286 R.getEnd()));
2287}
2288
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002289/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2290/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2291/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002292ExprResult
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002293Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2294 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002295 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002296 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002297
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002298 if (isType) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002299 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00002300 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo);
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002301 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002302 }
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002303
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002304 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002305 ExprResult Result
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002306 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2307
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002308 return move(Result);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002309}
2310
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002311QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002312 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2313 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002314
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002315 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002316 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002317 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002318
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002319 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2320 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2321 return V->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002322
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00002323 // Test for placeholders.
2324 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(V, Loc);
2325 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
2326 if (PR.take() != V) {
2327 V = PR.take();
2328 return CheckRealImagOperand(V, Loc, isReal);
2329 }
2330
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002331 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002332 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2333 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002334 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002335}
2336
2337
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002338
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002339ExprResult
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002340Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002341 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002342 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002343 switch (Kind) {
2344 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002345 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PostInc; break;
2346 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002347 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002348
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002349 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002350}
2351
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002352ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002353Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2354 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002355 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002356 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002357 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2358 Base = Result.take();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002359
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002360 Expr *LHSExp = Base, *RHSExp = Idx;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002361
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002362 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002363 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002364 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2365 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2366 }
2367
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002368 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002369 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman03f332a2008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002370 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2371 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2372 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002373 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, Base, Idx);
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002374 }
2375
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002376 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Base, LLoc, Idx, RLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002377}
2378
2379
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002380ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002381Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2382 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2383 Expr *LHSExp = Base;
2384 Expr *RHSExp = Idx;
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002385
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002386 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002387 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2388 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2389 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002390
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002391 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002392
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002393 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002394 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002395 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002396 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002397 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2398 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002399 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2400 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2401 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2402 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002403 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002404 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2405 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002406 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002407 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner7a2e0472007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002408 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002409 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2410 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002411 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002412 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002413 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002414 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2415 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2416 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002417 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002418 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002419 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2420 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2421 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2422 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002423 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattnerc8629632007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002424 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002425 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begeman334a8022009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002426
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002427 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2428 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002429 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2430 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002431 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002432 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2433 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2434 // force the promotion here.
2435 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2436 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002437 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002438 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002439 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2440
2441 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2442 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002443 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002444 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2445 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2446 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2447 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002448 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002449 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002450 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2451
2452 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2453 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002454 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002455 } else {
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002456 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2457 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002458 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002459 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00002460 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002461 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2462 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002463
Daniel Dunbar7e88a602009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002464 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinig0f9a5b52009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002465 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2466 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig76e2b712009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002467 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2468
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002469 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002470 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2471 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002472 // incomplete types are not object types.
2473 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2474 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2475 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2476 return ExprError();
2477 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002478
Abramo Bagnara46358452010-09-13 06:50:07 +00002479 if (ResultType->isVoidType() && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
2480 // GNU extension: subscripting on pointer to void
2481 Diag(LLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
2482 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2483 } else if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002484 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002485 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2486 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002487 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002488
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002489 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002490 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002491 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2492 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2493 return ExprError();
2494 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002495
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002496 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002497 ResultType, RLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002498}
2499
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002500QualType Sema::
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002501CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002502 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002503 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbar2ad32892009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002504 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2505 // see FIXME there.
2506 //
2507 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2508 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002509 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002510
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002511 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002512 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002513
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002514 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002515 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2516 // to be selected.
2517 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002518
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002519 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2520 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman131f4652009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002521 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002522
2523 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2524 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002525 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002526 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2527 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002528 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002529 do
2530 compStr++;
2531 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002532 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002533 do
2534 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002535 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002536 }
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002537
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002538 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002539 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2540 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002541 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
Benjamin Kramer476d8b82010-08-11 14:47:12 +00002542 << llvm::StringRef(compStr, 1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002543 return QualType();
2544 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002545
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002546 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2547 // operates on.
2548 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002549 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002550
2551 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002552 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002553
2554 while (*compStr) {
2555 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2556 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2557 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2558 return QualType();
2559 }
2560 }
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002561 }
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002562
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002563 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002564 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002565 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002566 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002567 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begeman0479a0b2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002568 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002569 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002570 if (HexSwizzle)
2571 CompSize--;
2572
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002573 if (CompSize == 1)
2574 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002575
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002576 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002577 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002578 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2579 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2580 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2581 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffbea0b342007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002582 }
2583 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002584}
2585
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002586static Decl *FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002587 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002588 const Selector &Sel,
2589 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002590 if (Member)
2591 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
2592 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002593 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002594 return OMD;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002595
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002596 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2597 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002598 if (Decl *D = FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
2599 Context))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002600 return D;
2601 }
2602 return 0;
2603}
2604
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002605static Decl *FindGetterSetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
2606 IdentifierInfo *Member,
2607 const Selector &Sel,
2608 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002609 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2610 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002611 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002612 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002613 if (Member)
2614 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
2615 GDecl = PD;
2616 break;
2617 }
2618 // Also must look for a getter or setter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002619 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002620 GDecl = OMD;
2621 break;
2622 }
2623 }
2624 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002625 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002626 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2627 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002628 GDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
2629 Context);
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002630 if (GDecl)
2631 return GDecl;
2632 }
2633 }
2634 return GDecl;
2635}
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002636
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002637ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002638Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002639 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002640 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2641 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002642 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002643 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002644 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2645 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2646 //
2647 // T* t;
2648 // t.f;
2649 //
2650 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2651 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2652 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2653 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002654 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002655 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2656 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002657 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002658 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002659 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002660 return ExprError();
2661 }
2662 }
2663
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002664 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2665 NameInfo.getName().isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002666 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002667
2668 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2669 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002670 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002671 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002672 SS.getScopeRep(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002673 SS.getRange(),
2674 FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002675 NameInfo, TemplateArgs));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002676}
2677
2678/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2679/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2680/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2681static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2682 Expr *BaseExpr,
2683 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002684 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002685 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002686 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2687 // diagnostics.
2688 if (!BaseExpr)
2689 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002690
John McCall110acc12010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002691 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2692 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002693}
2694
2695// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2696// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2697// type. The restriction here is:
2698//
2699// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2700// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2701// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2702//
2703// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2704// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2705// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2706// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2707bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2708 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002709 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002710 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002711 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2712 if (!BaseRT) {
2713 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2714 // dependent.
2715 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2716 return false;
2717 }
2718 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002719
2720 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002721 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2722 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002723 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002724 return false;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002725
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002726 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
Eli Friedman02463762010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002727 DeclContext *DC = (*I)->getDeclContext();
2728 while (DC->isTransparentContext())
2729 DC = DC->getParent();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002730
Douglas Gregor9d4bb942010-07-28 22:27:52 +00002731 if (!DC->isRecord())
2732 continue;
2733
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002734 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
Eli Friedman02463762010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002735 MemberRecord.insert(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getCanonicalDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002736
2737 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2738 return false;
2739 }
2740
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002741 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002742 return true;
2743}
2744
2745static bool
2746LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2747 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002748 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2749 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002750 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2751 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002752 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002753 << BaseRange))
2754 return true;
2755
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002756 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
2757 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
2758 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
2759
2760 bool MOUS;
2761 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
2762 return false;
2763 }
2764
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002765 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2766 if (SS.isSet()) {
2767 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2768 // nested-name-specifier.
2769 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2770
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002771 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002772 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2773 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2774 return true;
2775 }
2776
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002777 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002778
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002779 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2780 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2781 << DC << SS.getRange();
2782 return true;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002783 }
2784 }
2785
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002786 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2787 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002788
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002789 if (!R.empty())
2790 return false;
2791
2792 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2793 // for typos.
2794 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002795 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002796 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002797 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2798 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2799 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002800 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2801 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002802 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2803 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2804 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002805 return false;
2806 } else {
2807 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor12eb5d62010-06-29 19:27:42 +00002808 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002809 }
2810
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002811 return false;
2812}
2813
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002814ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002815Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *Base, QualType BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002816 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002817 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002818 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002819 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002820 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002821 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2822 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002823 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002824 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2825 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002826 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002827
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002828 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002829
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002830 // Implicit member accesses.
2831 if (!Base) {
2832 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2833 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2834 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2835 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002836 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002837 return ExprError();
2838
2839 // Explicit member accesses.
2840 } else {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002841 ExprResult Result =
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002842 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00002843 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ 0, TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002844
2845 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2846 Owned(Base);
2847 return ExprError();
2848 }
2849
2850 if (Result.get())
2851 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlf3e63372010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002852
2853 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2854 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002855 }
2856
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002857 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002858 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2859 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002860}
2861
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002862ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002863Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseExprType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002864 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2865 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002866 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002867 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002868 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2869 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002870 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002871 if (IsArrow) {
2872 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2873 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2874 }
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002875 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002876
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002877 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = SS.getScopeRep();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002878 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo = R.getLookupNameInfo();
2879 DeclarationName MemberName = MemberNameInfo.getName();
2880 SourceLocation MemberLoc = MemberNameInfo.getLoc();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002881
2882 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002883 return ExprError();
2884
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002885 if (R.empty()) {
2886 // Rederive where we looked up.
2887 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2888 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2889 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002890
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002891 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002892 << MemberName << DC
2893 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002894 return ExprError();
2895 }
2896
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002897 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2898 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2899 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2900 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2901 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2902 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2903 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2904 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2905 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2906 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002907 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002908 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002909 return ExprError();
2910
2911 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2912 // result.
2913 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002914 bool Dependent =
John McCall410a3f32009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002915 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002916 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002917 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002918
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002919 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2920 // pick a member.
2921 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2922
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002923 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2924 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2925 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002926 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2927 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002928 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002929 MemberNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002930 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002931
2932 return Owned(MemExpr);
2933 }
2934
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002935 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002936 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002937 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2938
2939 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2940
2941 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2942 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2943 // error cases.
2944 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2945 return ExprError();
2946
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002947 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2948 if (!BaseExpr) {
2949 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002950 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002951 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), MemberDecl);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002952
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002953 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2954 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2955 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2956 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002957 }
2958
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002959 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2960 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2961 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2962 // explicitly qualified.
2963 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2964 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2965 }
2966
2967 // Check the use of this member.
2968 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2969 Owned(BaseExpr);
2970 return ExprError();
2971 }
2972
2973 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2974 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2975 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman16c53782009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002976 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2977 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002978 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2979 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2980
2981 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2982 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2983 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2984 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2985 else {
2986 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2987 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2988 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2989
2990 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2991 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2992
2993 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2994 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2995 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2996 }
2997
2998 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002999 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003000 return ExprError();
3001 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003002 FD, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
3003 MemberType));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003004 }
3005
3006 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
3007 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
3008 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003009 Var, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003010 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
3011 }
3012
3013 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
3014 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
3015 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003016 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003017 MemberFn->getType()));
3018 }
3019
3020 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
3021 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
3022 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003023 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
3024 Enum->getType()));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003025 }
3026
3027 Owned(BaseExpr);
3028
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003029 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003030 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003031 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003032 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
3033 else
3034 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
3035 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003036
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003037 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
3038 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003039 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003040 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003041}
3042
3043/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
3044/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
3045/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
3046/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
3047/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
3048/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
3049/// an ordinary member expression.
3050///
3051/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
3052/// fixed for ObjC++.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003053ExprResult
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003054Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003055 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003056 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003057 Decl *ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003058 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003059
Steve Naroff3cc4af82007-12-16 21:42:28 +00003060 // Perform default conversions.
3061 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003062
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003063 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003064 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
3065
3066 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
3067 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003068
3069 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003070 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003071 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
3072 // call, and continue on.
3073 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3074 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
3075 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
3076 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
3077 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003078 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
3079 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003080 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
3081 ->isRecordType()))) {
3082 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
Nick Lewycky3d6c45d2010-10-15 21:43:24 +00003083 Diag(BaseExpr->getExprLoc(), diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003084 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003085 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003086
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003087 ExprResult NewBase
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003088 = ActOnCallExpr(0, BaseExpr, Loc, MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), Loc);
Douglas Gregorf918b832010-06-21 22:46:46 +00003089 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003090 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003091 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003092
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003093 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
3094 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
3095 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
3096 }
3097 }
3098 }
3099
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003100 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3101 // use that.
3102 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003103 if (IsArrow) {
3104 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
3105 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3106 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003107 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003108 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003109 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
3110 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003111 }
3112 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003113 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3114 // is a reference to 'isa'.
3115 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
3116 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003117 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003118 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003119 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003120
Fariborz Jahanian369a3bd2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003121 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3122 // use that.
3123 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
3124 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3125 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
3126 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
3127 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003128 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian369a3bd2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003129 }
3130 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003131
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003132 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003133
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003134 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003135 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003136 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
3137 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3138 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
3139 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
3140 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
3141 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
3142 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
3143 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
3144 // Check the use of this method.
3145 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3146 return ExprError();
3147 }
3148 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3149 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
3150 Selector SetterSel =
3151 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3152 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3153 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
3154 if (!Setter) {
3155 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3156 // methods.
Steve Naroffd789d3d2009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003157 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003158 }
3159 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
3160 if (!Setter)
3161 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003162
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003163 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3164 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003165
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003166 if (Getter || Setter) {
3167 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003168
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003169 if (Getter)
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003170 PType = Getter->getSendResultType();
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003171 else
3172 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3173 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3174 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003175 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003176 PType,
3177 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3178 }
3179 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3180 << MemberName << BaseType);
3181 }
3182 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003183
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003184 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3185 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3186 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003187 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003188 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003189
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003190 if (IsArrow) {
3191 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003192 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003193 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3194 ;
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003195 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3196 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3197 // struct MyRecord foo;
3198 // foo->bar
3199 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3200 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3201 // by now.
3202 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3203 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003204 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003205 IsArrow = false;
3206 } else {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003207 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3208 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3209 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson4ef27702009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003210 }
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003211 } else {
3212 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3213 // type *foo;
3214 // foo.bar
3215 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3216 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3217 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3218 // the appropriate pointer type
3219 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3220 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3221 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3222 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3223 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003224 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003225 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3226 IsArrow = true;
3227 }
3228 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003229 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003230
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003231 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003232 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003233 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003234 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003235 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003236 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003237 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003238
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003239 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3240 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003241 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003242 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003243 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003244 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3245 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3246 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3247 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003248 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3249
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003250 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003251 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003252
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003253 if (!IV) {
3254 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3255 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3256 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregor9a632ea2010-10-20 03:06:34 +00003257 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false,
3258 IsArrow? CTC_ObjCIvarLookup
3259 : CTC_ObjCPropertyLookup) &&
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003260 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003261 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003262 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3263 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003264 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3265 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003266 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003267 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor12eb5d62010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003268 } else {
3269 Res.clear();
3270 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003271 }
3272 }
3273
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003274 if (IV) {
3275 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3276 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3277 // error cases.
3278 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3279 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003280
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003281 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3282 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3283 return ExprError();
3284 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3285 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3286 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3287 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3288 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3289 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3290 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3291 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3292 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3293 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3294 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3295 // AST for a function decl.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003296 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003297 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003298 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3299 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003300 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003301 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3302 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003303
3304 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3305 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003306 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003307 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003308 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003309 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3310 // @protected
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003311 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003312 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffb06d8752009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003313 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003314
3315 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3316 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003317 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahanian935fd762009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003318 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003319 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003320 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003321 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianaaa63a72008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003322 }
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003323 }
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003324 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003325 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3326 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003327 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003328 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003329
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003330 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003331 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003332 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel,
3333 Context)) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003334 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3335 // Check the use of this declaration
3336 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3337 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003338
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003339 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
Fariborz Jahanian8ac2d442010-10-14 16:04:05 +00003340 MemberLoc,
3341 BaseExpr));
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003342 }
3343 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3344 // Check the use of this method.
3345 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3346 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003347 Selector SetterSel =
3348 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3349 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3350 ObjCMethodDecl *SMD = 0;
3351 if (Decl *SDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDecl(QIdTy, /*Property id*/0,
3352 SetterSel, Context))
3353 SMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(SDecl);
3354 QualType PType = OMD->getSendResultType();
3355 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(OMD, PType,
3356 SMD,
3357 MemberLoc,
3358 BaseExpr));
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003359 }
3360 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003361
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003362 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003363 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003364 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003365
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003366 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3367 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner7f816522010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003368 if (!IsArrow)
3369 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3370 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Fariborz Jahanian8ac2d442010-10-14 16:04:05 +00003371 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc,
3372 SourceLocation(), QualType(), false);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003373
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003374 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003375 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003376 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3377 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003378 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003379 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003380 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003381
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003382 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner73525de2009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003383 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003384 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003385 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3386 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003387 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003388 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003389 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003390 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003391
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003392 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3393 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3394
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003395 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003396}
3397
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003398/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3399/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3400/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3401/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3402/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3403///
3404/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3405/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3406/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3407/// only be called
3408/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3409/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3410/// aren't properly put in the context chain
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003411ExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003412 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3413 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003414 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003415 UnqualifiedId &Id,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003416 Decl *ObjCImpDecl,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003417 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3418 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3419 return ExprError();
3420
3421 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3422
3423 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003424 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003425 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3426 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003427 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003428
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003429 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003430 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3431
3432 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3433 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3434 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3435
3436 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003437 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003438 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3439 Base = Result.take();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003440
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003441 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3442 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003443 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003444 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3445 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003446 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003447 } else {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003448 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003449 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3450 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003451
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003452 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3453 Owned(Base);
3454 return ExprError();
3455 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003456
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003457 if (Result.get()) {
3458 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3459 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3460 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3461 // call now.
3462 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3463 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003464 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameInfo.getLoc(), Result.get());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003465
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003466 return move(Result);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003467 }
3468
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003469 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003470 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3471 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003472 }
3473
3474 return move(Result);
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003475}
3476
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003477ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003478 FunctionDecl *FD,
3479 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3480 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003481 Diag(CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003482 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3483 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003484 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003485 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003486 return ExprError();
3487 }
3488
3489 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3490 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003491
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003492 // Instantiate the expression.
3493 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3494 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson25cae7f2009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003495
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003496 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
3497 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3498 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3499 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003500
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003501 ExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
3502 if (Result.isInvalid())
3503 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003504
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003505 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3506 InitializedEntity Entity
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003507 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003508 InitializationKind Kind
3509 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3510 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3511 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003512
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003513 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
3514 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3515 MultiExprArg(*this, &ResultE, 1));
3516 if (Result.isInvalid())
3517 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003518
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003519 // Build the default argument expression.
3520 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
3521 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003522 }
3523
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003524 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3525 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3526 // be properly destroyed.
3527 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3528 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Douglas Gregor5833b0b2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00003529 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i) {
3530 CXXTemporary *Temporary = Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i);
3531 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Param->getDefaultArg()->getLocStart(),
3532 const_cast<CXXDestructorDecl*>(Temporary->getDestructor()));
3533 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Temporary);
3534 }
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003535
3536 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00003537 // Just mark all of the declarations in this potentially-evaluated expression
3538 // as being "referenced".
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003539 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Param->getDefaultArg());
Douglas Gregor036aed12009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003540 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003541}
3542
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003543/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3544/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3545/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3546/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3547/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3548/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003549bool
3550Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003551 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003552 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003553 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3554 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003555 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003556 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3557 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003558 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003559
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003560 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3561 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3562 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3563 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3564 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003565 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherd77b9a22010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003566 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003567 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003568 }
3569
3570 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3571 // them.
3572 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3573 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3574 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3575 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003576 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherccfa9632010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003577 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003578 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3579 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3580 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003581 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003582 return true;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003583 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003584 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003585 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003586 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003587 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3588 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3589 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3590 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3591 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003592 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian2fe168f2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003593 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003594 if (Invalid)
3595 return true;
3596 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3597 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3598 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003599
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003600 return false;
3601}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003602
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003603bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3604 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3605 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3606 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3607 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3608 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003609 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003610 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3611 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3612 bool Invalid = false;
3613 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3614 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3615 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3616 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003617 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003618 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003619 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003620
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003621 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003622 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3623 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003624
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003625 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3626 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003627 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003628 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003629 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003630
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003631 // Pass the argument
3632 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3633 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3634 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregoraa037312009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003635
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003636 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003637 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param)
3638 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, ProtoArgType);
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003639 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003640 SourceLocation(),
3641 Owned(Arg));
3642 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3643 return true;
3644
3645 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003646 } else {
Anders Carlssoned961f92009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003647 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003648
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003649 ExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003650 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003651 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3652 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003653
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003654 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003655 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003656 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003657 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003658
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003659 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003660 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003661 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003662 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003663 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003664 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003665 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003666 }
3667 }
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003668 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003669}
3670
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003671/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003672/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3673/// locations.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003674ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003675Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003676 MultiExprArg args, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003677 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003678
3679 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003680 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Fn);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003681 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3682 Fn = Result.take();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003683
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003684 Expr **Args = args.release();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003685
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003686 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003687 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3688 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3689 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3690 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3691 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003692 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003693 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3694 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003695
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003696 NumArgs = 0;
3697 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003698
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003699 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3700 RParenLoc));
3701 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003702
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003703 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003704 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003705 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3706 // Fn.
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003707 bool Dependent = false;
3708 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3709 Dependent = true;
3710 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3711 Dependent = true;
3712
3713 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003714 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003715 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3716
3717 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3718 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3719 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003720 RParenLoc));
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003721
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003722 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3723
3724 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3725 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3726 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3727 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3728 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3729 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3730 // method template.
3731 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003732 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3733 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor958aeb02009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003734 (void)MemE;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003735
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003736 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003737 RParenLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003738 }
3739
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003740 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003741 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003742 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003743 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003744 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003745 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003746 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003747
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003748 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003749 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003750 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD ||
3751 BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregor5f970ee2010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003752 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3753 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003754 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getCallResultType(Context);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003755
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003756 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall
3757 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
3758 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3759 RParenLoc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003760
3761 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3762 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003763 TheCall, 0))
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003764 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8d6d90d2009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003765
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003766 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003767 RParenLoc))
3768 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003769
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003770 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003771 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003772 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003773 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3774 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003775 }
3776 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003777 }
3778
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003779 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003780 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor6db8ed42009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003781 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003782
Eli Friedmanefa42f72009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003783 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
Douglas Gregoref9b1492010-11-09 20:03:54 +00003784 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3785 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
3786 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3787 RParenLoc);
3788 }
3789
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003790 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
Douglas Gregord8f0ade2010-10-25 20:48:33 +00003791 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(NakedFn))
3792 if (UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf)
3793 NakedFn = UnOp->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
3794
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003795 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3796 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3797
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003798 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3799}
3800
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003801/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3802/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003803/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3804/// block-pointer type.
3805///
3806/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003807ExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003808Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3809 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3810 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3811 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3812 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3813
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003814 // Promote the function operand.
3815 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3816
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003817 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3818 // of arguments and function on error.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003819 CallExpr *TheCall = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3820 Args, NumArgs,
3821 Context.BoolTy,
3822 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003823
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003824 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3825 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3826 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3827 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003828 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003829 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003830 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3831 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003832 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003833 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003834 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003835 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003836 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003837 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003838 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3839 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3840
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003841 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003842 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003843 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall,
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003844 FDecl))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003845 return ExprError();
3846
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003847 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003848 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003849
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003850 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003851 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003852 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003853 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003854 } else {
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003855 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003856
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003857 if (FDecl) {
3858 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3859 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3860 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis06a54a32010-07-07 11:31:19 +00003861 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003862 const FunctionProtoType *Proto
3863 = Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
3864 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size()))
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003865 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3866 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003867 }
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003868
3869 // If the function we're calling isn't a function prototype, but we have
3870 // a function prototype from a prior declaratiom, use that prototype.
3871 if (!FDecl->hasPrototype())
3872 Proto = FDecl->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003873 }
3874
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003875 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003876 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3877 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003878
3879 if (Proto && i < Proto->getNumArgs()) {
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003880 InitializedEntity Entity
3881 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
3882 Proto->getArgType(i));
3883 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
3884 SourceLocation(),
3885 Owned(Arg));
3886 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3887 return true;
3888
3889 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
3890
3891 } else {
3892 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00003893 }
3894
Douglas Gregor0700bbf2010-10-26 05:45:40 +00003895 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3896 Arg->getType(),
3897 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3898 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
3899 return ExprError();
3900
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003901 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003902 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003903 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003904
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003905 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3906 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003907 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3908 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003909
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003910 // Check for sentinels
3911 if (NDecl)
3912 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003913
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003914 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003915 if (FDecl) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003916 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003917 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003918
Douglas Gregor7814e6d2009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003919 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003920 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall);
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003921 } else if (NDecl) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003922 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003923 return ExprError();
3924 }
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003925
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003926 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003927}
3928
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003929ExprResult
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00003930Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003931 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) {
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003932 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroffaff1edd2007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003933 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003934 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003935
3936 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3937 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3938 if (!TInfo)
3939 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3940
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003941 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003942}
3943
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003944ExprResult
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003945Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003946 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *literalExpr) {
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003947 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Anders Carlssond35c8322007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003948
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003949 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidise6fe9a22010-11-08 19:14:19 +00003950 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Context.getBaseElementType(literalType),
3951 PDiag(diag::err_illegal_decl_array_incomplete_type)
3952 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
3953 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
3954 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003955 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003956 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3957 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor690dc7f2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003958 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3959 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003960 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003961 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003962 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003963 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003964
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003965 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregord6542d82009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003966 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003967 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003968 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003969 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003970 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003971 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
John McCallca0408f2010-08-23 06:44:23 +00003972 MultiExprArg(*this, &literalExpr, 1),
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003973 &literalType);
3974 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003975 return ExprError();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003976 literalExpr = Result.get();
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003977
Chris Lattner371f2582008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003978 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003979 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003980 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003981 return ExprError();
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003982 }
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003983
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003984 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003985 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003986}
3987
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003988ExprResult
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003989Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003990 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3991 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003992 Expr **InitList = initlist.release();
Anders Carlsson66b5a8a2007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003993
Steve Naroff08d92e42007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003994 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003995 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003996
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003997 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3998 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003999 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004000 return Owned(E);
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00004001}
4002
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004003static CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004004 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004005 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004006 return CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004007
4008 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
4009 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004010 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004011 CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
4012 CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004013 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004014 return CK_PointerToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004015 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004016
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004017 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
4018 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004019 return CK_IntegralCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004020 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004021 return CK_IntegralToPointer;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004022 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004023 return CK_IntegralToFloating;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004024 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004025
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004026 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
4027 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004028 return CK_FloatingCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004029 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004030 return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004031 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004032
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004033 // FIXME: Assert here.
4034 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004035 return CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004036}
4037
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004038/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redlef0cb8e2009-07-29 13:50:23 +00004039bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004040 CastKind& Kind,
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004041 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahaniane9f42082009-08-26 18:55:36 +00004042 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00004043 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor40749ee2010-11-03 00:35:38 +00004044 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(SourceRange(TyR.getBegin(),
4045 castExpr->getLocEnd()),
4046 castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004047 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00004048
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004049 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004050
4051 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
4052 // type needs to be scalar.
4053 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
4054 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004055 Kind = CK_ToVoid;
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00004056 return false;
4057 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004058
Eli Friedman8d438082010-07-17 20:43:49 +00004059 if (RequireCompleteType(TyR.getBegin(), castType,
4060 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
4061 return true;
4062
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00004063 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004064 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004065 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
4066 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004067 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004068 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
4069 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004070 Kind = CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004071 return false;
4072 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004073
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004074 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004075 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004076 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004077 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004078 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004079 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004080 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Abramo Bagnara8c4bfe52010-10-07 21:20:44 +00004081 castExpr->getType()) &&
4082 !Field->isUnnamedBitfield()) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004083 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
4084 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4085 break;
4086 }
4087 }
4088 if (Field == FieldEnd)
4089 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
4090 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004091 Kind = CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004092 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004093 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004094
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004095 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
4096 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4097 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4098 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004099
4100 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004101 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004102 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4103 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004104 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004105 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004106
4107 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004108 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004109
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004110 if (castType->isVectorType())
4111 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
4112 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
4113 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
4114
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004115 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
4116 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004117
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004118 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004119 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004120 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor2ade35e2010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004121 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004122 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4123 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
4124 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4125 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004126 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004127 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4128 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
4129 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004130 }
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004131
4132 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
John McCallb7f4ffe2010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004133
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004134 if (Kind == CK_Unknown || Kind == CK_BitCast)
John McCallb7f4ffe2010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004135 CheckCastAlign(castExpr, castType, TyR);
4136
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004137 return false;
4138}
4139
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004140bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004141 CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004142 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004143
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004144 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00004145 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004146 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004147 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004148 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004149 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004150 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004151 } else
4152 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004153 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004154 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004155
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004156 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004157 return false;
4158}
4159
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004160bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004161 CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004162 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004163
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004164 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004165
Nate Begeman9b10da62009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004166 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4167 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004168 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4169 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4170 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4171 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004172 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004173 return false;
4174 }
4175
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004176 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004177 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4178 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004179 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4180 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4181 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4182 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004183
4184 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4185 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
4186 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004187
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004188 Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004189 return false;
4190}
4191
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004192ExprResult
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004193Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004194 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
4195 assert((Ty != 0) && (castExpr != 0) &&
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004196 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff16beff82007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004197
John McCall9d125032010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004198 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4199 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4200 if (!castTInfo)
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004201 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004202
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004203 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
4204 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004205 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, castExpr,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004206 castTInfo);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004207
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004208 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, castExpr);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004209}
4210
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004211ExprResult
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004212Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004213 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004214 CastKind Kind = CK_Unknown;
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004215 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004216 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004217 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004218 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson0aebc812009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004219
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004220 return Owned(CStyleCastExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004221 Ty->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004222 Kind, castExpr, &BasePath, Ty,
4223 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004224}
4225
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004226/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4227/// of comma binary operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004228ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004229Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *expr) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004230 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4231 if (!E)
4232 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004233
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004234 ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004235
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004236 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004237 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(),
4238 E->getExpr(i));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004239
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004240 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4241
4242 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004243}
4244
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004245ExprResult
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004246Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004247 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *Op,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004248 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004249 ParenListExpr *PE = cast<ParenListExpr>(Op);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004250 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004251 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004252
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004253 // Check for an altivec literal,
4254 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004255 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4256 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4257 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4258 return ExprError();
4259 }
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004260 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4261 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4262 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4263 }
4264 else
4265 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4266 }
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004267
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004268 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4269 // then handle it as such.
4270 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004271 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4272 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4273 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4274
4275 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4276 // braces instead of the original commas.
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004277 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4278 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004279 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4280 E->setType(Ty);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004281 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, E);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004282 } else {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004283 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004284 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004285 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Op);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004286 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4287 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Result.take());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004288 }
4289}
4290
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004291ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004292 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004293 MultiExprArg Val,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004294 ParsedType TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004295 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4296 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004297 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4298 Expr *expr;
4299 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4300 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4301 else
4302 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004303 return Owned(expr);
4304}
4305
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004306/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4307/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004308/// C99 6.5.15
4309QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004310 Expr *&SAVE,
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004311 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Douglas Gregor7ad5d422010-11-09 21:07:58 +00004312 // If both LHS and RHS are overloaded functions, try to resolve them.
4313 if (Context.hasSameType(LHS->getType(), RHS->getType()) &&
4314 LHS->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Overload)) {
4315 ExprResult LHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS, QuestionLoc);
4316 if (LHSResult.isInvalid())
4317 return QualType();
4318
4319 ExprResult RHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS, QuestionLoc);
4320 if (RHSResult.isInvalid())
4321 return QualType();
4322
4323 LHS = LHSResult.take();
4324 RHS = RHSResult.take();
4325 }
4326
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004327 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4328 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004329 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, SAVE, QuestionLoc);
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004330
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004331 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004332 if (SAVE) {
4333 SAVE = LHS = Cond;
4334 }
4335 else
4336 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004337 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4338 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4339 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4340 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004341
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004342 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004343 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
Nate Begeman6155d732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004344 // OpenCL: Sec 6.3.i says the condition is allowed to be a vector or scalar.
4345 // Throw an error if its not either.
4346 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL) {
4347 if (!CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4348 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(),
4349 diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar_or_vector)
4350 << CondTy;
4351 return QualType();
4352 }
4353 }
4354 else {
4355 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4356 << CondTy;
4357 return QualType();
4358 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004359 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004360
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004361 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004362 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4363 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004364
Nate Begeman6155d732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004365 // OpenCL: If the condition is a vector, and both operands are scalar,
4366 // attempt to implicity convert them to the vector type to act like the
4367 // built in select.
4368 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL && CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4369 // Both operands should be of scalar type.
4370 if (!LHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4371 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4372 << CondTy;
4373 return QualType();
4374 }
4375 if (!RHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4376 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4377 << CondTy;
4378 return QualType();
4379 }
4380 // Implicity convert these scalars to the type of the condition.
4381 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4382 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4383 }
4384
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004385 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4386 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004387 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4388 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4389 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004390 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004391
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004392 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4393 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004394 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4395 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004396 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004397 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004398 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004399 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004400 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004401 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004402
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004403 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004404 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004405 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4406 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4407 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4408 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4409 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4410 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4411 << LHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004412 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
4413 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman0e724012008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004414 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004415 }
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004416 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4417 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004418 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004419 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004420 // promote the null to a pointer.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004421 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004422 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004423 }
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004424 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004425 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004426 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004427 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004428 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004429
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004430 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4431 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4432 QuestionLoc);
4433 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4434 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004435
4436
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004437 // Handle block pointer types.
4438 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4439 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4440 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4441 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004442 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
4443 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004444 return destType;
4445 }
4446 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004447 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004448 return QualType();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004449 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004450 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4451 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4452 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004453 return LHSTy;
4454 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004455 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004456 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4457 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004458
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004459 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4460 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004461 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004462 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004463 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4464 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4465 // to get a consistent AST.
4466 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004467 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4468 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004469 return incompatTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004470 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004471 // The block pointer types are compatible.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004472 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4473 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff91588042009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004474 return LHSTy;
4475 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004476
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004477 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4478 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4479 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004480 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4481 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004482
4483 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4484 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4485 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004486 QualType destPointee
4487 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004488 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004489 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004490 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004491 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004492 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004493 return destType;
4494 }
4495 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004496 QualType destPointee
4497 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004498 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004499 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004500 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004501 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004502 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004503 return destType;
4504 }
4505
4506 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4507 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4508 return LHSTy;
4509 }
4510 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4511 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4512 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4513 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4514 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4515 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4516 // to get a consistent AST.
4517 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004518 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4519 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004520 return incompatTy;
4521 }
4522 // The pointer types are compatible.
4523 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4524 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4525 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4526 // type.
4527 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4528 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004529 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4530 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004531 return LHSTy;
4532 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004533
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004534 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4535 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4536 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4537 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004538 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004539 return RHSTy;
4540 }
4541 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4542 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4543 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004544 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004545 return LHSTy;
4546 }
Daniel Dunbar5e155f02008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004547
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004548 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004549 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4550 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004551 return QualType();
4552}
4553
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004554/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4555/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4556QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4557 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4558 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4559 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004560
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004561 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4562 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4563 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4564 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4565 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004566 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004567 return LHSTy;
4568 }
4569 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4570 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004571 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004572 return RHSTy;
4573 }
4574 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4575 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4576 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004577 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004578 return LHSTy;
4579 }
4580 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4581 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004582 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004583 return RHSTy;
4584 }
4585 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4586 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4587 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004588 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004589 return LHSTy;
4590 }
4591 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4592 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004593 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004594 return RHSTy;
4595 }
4596 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4597 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004598
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004599 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4600 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4601 return LHSTy;
4602 }
4603 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4604 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4605 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004606
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004607 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4608 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4609 // type. This allows
4610 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4611 // where B is a subclass of A.
4612 //
4613 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4614 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4615 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4616 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004617
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004618 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4619 // It could return the composite type.
4620 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4621 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4622 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4623 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4624 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4625 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4626 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4627 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4628 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4629 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4630 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4631 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4632 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4633 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004634 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004635 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4636 ;
4637 else {
4638 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4639 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4640 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4641 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004642 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4643 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004644 return incompatTy;
4645 }
4646 // The object pointer types are compatible.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004647 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
4648 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004649 return compositeType;
4650 }
4651 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4652 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4653 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4654 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4655 QualType destPointee
4656 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4657 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4658 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004659 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004660 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004661 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004662 return destType;
4663 }
4664 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4665 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4666 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4667 QualType destPointee
4668 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4669 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4670 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004671 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004672 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004673 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004674 return destType;
4675 }
4676 return QualType();
4677}
4678
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004679/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004680/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004681ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004682 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004683 Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr,
4684 Expr *RHSExpr) {
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004685 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4686 // was the condition.
4687 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
Fariborz Jahanianf9b949f2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004688 Expr *SAVEExpr = 0;
4689 if (isLHSNull) {
4690 LHSExpr = SAVEExpr = CondExpr;
4691 }
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004692
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004693 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
4694 SAVEExpr, QuestionLoc);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004695 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004696 return ExprError();
4697
Douglas Gregor47e1f7c2009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004698 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Fariborz Jahanianf9b949f2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004699 LHSExpr, ColonLoc,
4700 RHSExpr, SAVEExpr,
4701 result));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004702}
4703
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004704// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004705// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004706// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4707// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4708// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004709Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004710Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
4711 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004712
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004713 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4714 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4715 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4716 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4717 return Compatible;
4718 }
4719
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004720 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004721 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4722 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004723
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004724 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004725 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4726 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004727
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004728 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004729
4730 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4731 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4732 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianf11284a2009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004733 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004734 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004735 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004736
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004737 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4738 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004739 // version of void...
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004740 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004741 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004742 return ConvTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004743
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004744 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004745 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4746 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004747 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004748
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004749 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004750 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004751 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004752
4753 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004754 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4755 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004756 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004757 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004758 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004759 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4760 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4761 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4762 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4763 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4764 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004765 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004766 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004767 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004768 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004769
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004770 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004771 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004772 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004773 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004774
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004775 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4776 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4777 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4778 // warning can be disabled.
4779 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4780 return ConvTy;
4781 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4782 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004783
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004784 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4785 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4786 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4787 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4788 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4789 do {
4790 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4791 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004792
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004793 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4794 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4795 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004796
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004797 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004798 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004799 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004800
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004801 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004802 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004803 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004804 return ConvTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004805}
4806
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004807/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4808/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4809/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4810// types.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004811Sema::AssignConvertType
4812Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004813 QualType rhsType) {
4814 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004815
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004816 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004817 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4818 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004819
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004820 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4821 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4822 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004823
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004824 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004825
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004826 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004827 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004828 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004829
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004830 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4831 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4832 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4833 }
4834 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004835 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004836 return ConvTy;
4837}
4838
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004839/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4840/// for assignment compatibility.
4841Sema::AssignConvertType
4842Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004843 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4844 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004845 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4846 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004847 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004848 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004849 }
4850 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4851 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004852 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4853 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004854 return IncompatiblePointer;
4855 return Compatible;
4856 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004857 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004858 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004859 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004860 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4861 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4862 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4863 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4864 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4865 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004866
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004867 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4868 return Compatible;
4869 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4870 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004871 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004872}
4873
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004874/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4875/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004876/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4877///
4878/// int a, *pint;
4879/// short *pshort;
4880/// struct foo *pfoo;
4881///
4882/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4883/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4884/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4885/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4886///
4887/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004888/// C99 spec dictates.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004889///
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004890Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004891Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004892 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4893 // them.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004894 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4895 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004896
4897 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerd2656dd2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004898 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff700204c2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004899
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004900 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4901 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4902 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4903 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4904 return Compatible;
4905 }
4906
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004907 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4908 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4909 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4910 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4911 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4912 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4913 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004914 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004915 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson793680e2007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004916 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004917 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahanian411f3732007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004918 }
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004919 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4920 // to the same ExtVector type.
4921 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4922 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4923 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00004924 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004925 return Compatible;
4926 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004927
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004928 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004929 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
4930 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
4931 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
4932 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
4933 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4934 (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)))
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004935 return IncompatibleVectors;
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004936
4937 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
4938 // vector type and vice versa
4939 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType))
4940 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnere8b3e962008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004941 }
4942 return Incompatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004943 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004944
Douglas Gregor88623ad2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004945 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4946 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004947 return Compatible;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004948
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004949 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004950 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004951 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004952
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004953 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004954 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004955
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004956 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004957 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004958 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4959 return Compatible;
4960 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004961 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004962 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4963 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004964 return Compatible;
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004965
4966 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004967 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004968 return Compatible;
4969 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004970 return Incompatible;
4971 }
4972
4973 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4974 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedmand8f4f432009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004975 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004976
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004977 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004978 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004979 return Compatible;
4980
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004981 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4982 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004983
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004984 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004985 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004986 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004987 }
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004988 return Incompatible;
4989 }
4990
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004991 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4992 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4993 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004994
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004995 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004996 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004997 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4998 return Compatible;
4999 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005000 }
5001 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00005002 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005003 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005004 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005005 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
5006 return Compatible;
5007 }
5008 // Treat block pointers as objects.
5009 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
5010 return Compatible;
5011 return Incompatible;
5012 }
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00005013 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005014 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005015 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
5016 return Compatible;
5017
5018 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00005019 return PointerToInt;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005020
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005021 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005022 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005023
5024 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005025 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00005026 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005027 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005028 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005029 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
5030 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
5031 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
5032 return Compatible;
5033
5034 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
5035 return PointerToInt;
5036
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005037 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005038 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005039 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
5040 return Compatible;
5041 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005042 }
5043 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005044 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005045 return Compatible;
5046 return Incompatible;
5047 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005048
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005049 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00005050 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005051 return Compatible;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005052 }
5053 return Incompatible;
5054}
5055
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005056/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
5057/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005058static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005059 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
5060 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
5061 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00005062 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenekba7bc552010-02-19 01:50:18 +00005063 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005064 SourceLocation());
5065 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
5066 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
5067
5068 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
5069 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00005070 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00005071 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00005072 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005073}
5074
5075Sema::AssignConvertType
5076Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
5077 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
5078
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005079 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005080 // transparent_union GCC extension.
5081 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00005082 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005083 return Incompatible;
5084
5085 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
5086 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
5087 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
5088 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00005089 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
5090 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005091 it != itend; ++it) {
5092 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
5093 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
5094 // 1) void pointer
5095 // 2) null pointer constant
5096 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005097 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005098 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005099 InitField = *it;
5100 break;
5101 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005102
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005103 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005104 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005105 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005106 InitField = *it;
5107 break;
5108 }
5109 }
5110
5111 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
5112 == Compatible) {
Daniel Dunbar41e11a92010-09-17 23:21:43 +00005113 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005114 InitField = *it;
5115 break;
5116 }
5117 }
5118
5119 if (!InitField)
5120 return Incompatible;
5121
5122 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
5123 return Compatible;
5124}
5125
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005126Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005127Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005128 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5129 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
5130 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
5131 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
5132 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00005133 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005134 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005135 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner2c4463f2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00005136 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005137 }
5138
5139 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
5140 // structures.
5141 }
5142
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005143 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
5144 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005145 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
5146 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005147 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005148 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005149 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005150 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005151 return Compatible;
5152 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005153
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005154 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005155 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregor02a24ee2009-11-03 16:56:39 +00005156 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Nick Lewyckyc133e9e2010-08-05 06:27:49 +00005157 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005158 //
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005159 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005160 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005161 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005162
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005163 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
5164 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005165
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005166 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
5167 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00005168 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
5169 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
5170 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
5171 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005172 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +00005173 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005174 CK_Unknown);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005175 return result;
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005176}
5177
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005178QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005179 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00005180 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005181 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005182 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005183}
5184
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005185QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005186 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005187 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005188 QualType lhsType =
5189 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5190 QualType rhsType =
5191 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005192
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005193 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005194 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005195 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005196
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005197 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
5198 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005199 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005200 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chandler Carruth629f9e42010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005201 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005202 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005203 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005204 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005205 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005206 return lhsType;
5207 }
5208
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005209 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005210 return rhsType;
Eric Christophere84f9eb2010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005211 } else if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) ==Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)){
5212 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
5213 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a
5214 // bitcast; no bits are changed but the result type is different.
5215 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
5216 return lhsType;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005217 }
Eric Christophere84f9eb2010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005218 }
Chandler Carruth629f9e42010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005219 }
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005220 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005221
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005222 // Handle the case of equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
5223 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType() &&
5224 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005225 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005226 return rhsType;
5227 }
5228
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005229 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5230 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5231 bool swapped = false;
5232 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5233 swapped = true;
5234 std::swap(rex, lex);
5235 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5236 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005237
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005238 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005239 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005240 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00005241 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005242 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005243 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005244 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5245 return lhsType;
5246 }
5247 }
5248 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5249 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5250 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005251 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005252 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5253 return lhsType;
5254 }
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005255 }
5256 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005257
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005258 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005259 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005260 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005261 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005262 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005263}
5264
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005265QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5266 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar69d1d002009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005267 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005268 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005269
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005270 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005271
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005272 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5273 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5274 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005275
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005276 // Check for division by zero.
5277 if (isDiv &&
5278 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005279 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005280 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005281
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005282 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005283}
5284
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005285QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005286 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005287 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005288 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5289 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005290 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5291 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5292 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005293
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005294 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005295
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005296 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5297 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005298
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005299 // Check for remainder by zero.
5300 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005301 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5302 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005303
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005304 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005305}
5306
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005307QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005308 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005309 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5310 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5311 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5312 return compType;
5313 }
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005314
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005315 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005316
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005317 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005318 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5319 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5320 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005321 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005322 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005323
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005324 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5325 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005326 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005327 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5328
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005329 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005330
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005331 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005332 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005333
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005334 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5335 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005336 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5337 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005338 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005339 return QualType();
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005340 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005341
5342 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5343 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5344 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005345 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005346 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5347 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5348 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5349 return QualType();
5350 }
5351
5352 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5353 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5354 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005355 } else {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005356 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005357 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005358 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005359 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5360 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005361 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5362 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005363 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005364 return QualType();
5365 }
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005366 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005367 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005368 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5369 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5370 return QualType();
5371 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005372
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005373 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005374 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5375 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5376 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5377 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5378 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005379 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005380 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5381 }
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005382 return PExp->getType();
5383 }
5384 }
5385
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005386 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005387}
5388
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005389// C99 6.5.6
5390QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005391 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5392 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5393 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5394 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5395 return compType;
5396 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005397
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005398 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005399
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005400 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005401
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005402 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005403 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5404 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005405 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005406 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005407 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005408
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005409 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005410 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff430ee5a2009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005411 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005412
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005413 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005414
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005415 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5416 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5417 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5418 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5419 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5420 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5421 return QualType();
5422 }
5423
5424 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5425 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5426 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5427 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5428 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005429 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005430 return QualType();
5431 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005432
5433 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5434 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5435 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005436 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005437 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005438 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005439 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005440 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005441
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005442 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005443 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005444 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5445 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5446 return QualType();
5447 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005448
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005449 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005450 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5451 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5452 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5453 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5454 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5455 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005456 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005457 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5458
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005459 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005460 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005461 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005462
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005463 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005464 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman8e54ad02008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005465 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005466
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005467 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5468 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5469 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5470 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5471 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5472 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5473 return QualType();
5474 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005475
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005476 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5477 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5478 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5479 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005480 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005481 return QualType();
5482 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005483
5484 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5485 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5486 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5487 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5488 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005489 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5490 << rex->getSourceRange()
5491 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005492 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005493
Eli Friedman88d936b2009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005494 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5495 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5496 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5497 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5498 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5499 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5500 return QualType();
5501 }
5502 } else {
5503 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5504 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5505 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5506 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5507 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5508 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5509 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5510 return QualType();
5511 }
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005512 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005513
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005514 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5515 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5516 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5517 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5518 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005519 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005520 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005521
5522 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005523 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5524 }
5525 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005526
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005527 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005528}
5529
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005530static bool isScopedEnumerationType(QualType T) {
5531 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(T))
5532 return ET->getDecl()->isScoped();
5533 return false;
5534}
5535
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005536// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005537QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005538 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005539 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005540 if (!lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
5541 !rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005542 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005543
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005544 // C++0x: Don't allow scoped enums. FIXME: Use something better than
5545 // hasIntegerRepresentation() above instead of this.
5546 if (isScopedEnumerationType(lex->getType()) ||
5547 isScopedEnumerationType(rex->getType())) {
5548 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5549 }
5550
Nate Begeman2207d792009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005551 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5552 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5553 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5554
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005555 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5556 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005557 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5558 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5559 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5560 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5561 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005562 }
Chris Lattner1dcf2c82007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005563 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005564 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005565
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005566 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005567
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005568 // Sanity-check shift operands
5569 llvm::APSInt Right;
5570 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar3f180c62009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005571 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5572 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn8045c732009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005573 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005574 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5575 else {
5576 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5577 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5578 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5579 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5580 }
5581 }
5582
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005583 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005584 return LHSTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005585}
5586
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005587static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
5588 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
5589 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
5590 return true;
5591 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
5592 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
5593 }
5594 return false;
5595}
5596
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005597// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005598QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005599 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005600 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) OpaqueOpc;
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005601
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005602 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005603 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005604 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005605
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005606 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5607 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005608
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005609 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
Ted Kremenekfbcb0eb2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00005610 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational) &&
5611 !lex->getLocStart().isMacroID() &&
5612 !rex->getLocStart().isMacroID()) {
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005613 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5614 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5615 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth64d092c2010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005616 //
5617 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
5618 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
5619 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
5620 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
5621 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
5622 // result.
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005623 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5624 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005625 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005626 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Ted Kremenekfbcb0eb2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00005627 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005628 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005629 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5630 << 0 // self-
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005631 << (Opc == BO_EQ
5632 || Opc == BO_LE
5633 || Opc == BO_GE));
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005634 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5635 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5636 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5637 // what is it always going to eval to?
5638 char always_evals_to;
5639 switch(Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005640 case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005641 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5642 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005643 case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005644 always_evals_to = 1; // true
5645 break;
5646 default:
5647 // best we can say is 'a constant'
5648 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
5649 break;
5650 }
5651 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5652 << 1 // array
5653 << always_evals_to);
5654 }
5655 }
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005656 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005657
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005658 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5659 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5660 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5661 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005662
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005663 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5664 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005665 Expr *literalString = 0;
5666 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005667 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005668 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005669 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005670 literalString = lex;
5671 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005672 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5673 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005674 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005675 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005676 literalString = rex;
5677 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5678 }
5679
5680 if (literalString) {
5681 std::string resultComparison;
5682 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005683 case BO_LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5684 case BO_GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5685 case BO_LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5686 case BO_GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5687 case BO_EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5688 case BO_NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005689 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5690 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005691
Douglas Gregord1e4d9b2010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005692 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5693 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5694 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek03a4bee2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005695 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005696 }
Ted Kremenek3ca0bf22007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005697 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005698
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005699 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
5700 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5701 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5702 else {
5703 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5704 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5705 }
5706
5707 lType = lex->getType();
5708 rType = rex->getType();
5709
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005710 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005711 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005712
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005713 if (isRelational) {
5714 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005715 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005716 } else {
Ted Kremenek72cb1ae2007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005717 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005718 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005719 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005720
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005721 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005722 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005723 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005724
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005725 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005726 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005727 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005728 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005729
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005730 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5731 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff77878cc2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005732 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005733 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005734 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005735 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005736 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005737
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005738 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005739 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5740 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005741 if (!isRelational &&
5742 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5743 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5744 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005745 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
5746 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005747 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5748 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005749 Diag(Loc,
5750 isSFINAEContext()?
5751 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
5752 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005753 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005754
5755 if (isSFINAEContext())
5756 return QualType();
5757
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005758 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005759 return ResultTy;
5760 }
5761 }
Anders Carlsson0c8209e2010-11-04 03:17:43 +00005762
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005763 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5764 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5765 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5766 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5767 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5768 //
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005769 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005770 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005771 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005772 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005773 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005774 if (T.isNull()) {
5775 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5776 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5777 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005778 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005779 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005780 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005781 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005782 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005783 }
5784
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005785 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5786 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005787 return ResultTy;
5788 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005789 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5790 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5791 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5792 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5793 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5794 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5795 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5796 }
5797 } else if (!isRelational &&
5798 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5799 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5800 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5801 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5802 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5803 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5804 }
5805 } else {
5806 // Invalid
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005807 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005808 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005809 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005810 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005811 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005812 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe77fd3c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005813 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005814
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005815 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Anders Carlsson0c8209e2010-11-04 03:17:43 +00005816 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
5817 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5818 return ResultTy;
5819
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005820 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005821 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005822 if (RHSIsNull &&
Anders Carlsson0c8209e2010-11-04 03:17:43 +00005823 ((lType->isPointerType() || lType->isNullPtrType()) ||
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005824 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregor443c2122010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005825 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
5826 lType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005827 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5828 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005829 return ResultTy;
5830 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005831 if (LHSIsNull &&
Anders Carlsson0c8209e2010-11-04 03:17:43 +00005832 ((rType->isPointerType() || rType->isNullPtrType()) ||
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005833 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregor443c2122010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005834 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
5835 rType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005836 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5837 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005838 return ResultTy;
5839 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005840
5841 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005842 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005843 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5844 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005845 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5846 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5847 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5848 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5849 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5850 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5851 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5852 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005853 // types.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005854 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005855 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005856 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005857 if (T.isNull()) {
5858 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005859 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005860 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005861 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005862 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005863 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005864 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005865 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005866 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005867
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005868 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5869 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005870 return ResultTy;
5871 }
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005872 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005873
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005874 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005875 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005876 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5877 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005878
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005879 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedman26784c12009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005880 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005881 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005882 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005883 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005884 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005885 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005886 }
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005887 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005888 if (!isRelational
5889 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5890 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005891 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005892 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005893 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005894 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005895 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5896 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5897 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005898 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005899 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005900 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005901 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005902
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005903 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005904 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005905 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5906 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005907 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005908 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005909 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005910 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005911
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005912 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5913 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005914 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005915 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005916 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005917 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005918 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff87f3b932008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005919 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005920 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005921 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005922 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5923 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005924 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005925 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff20373222008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005926 }
Fariborz Jahanian7359f042007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005927 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005928 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
5929 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005930 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005931 bool isError = false;
5932 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
5933 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
5934 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005935 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005936 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005937 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005938 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5939 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5940 isError = true;
5941 } else
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005942 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005943
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005944 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005945 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattner149f1382009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005946 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005947 if (isError)
5948 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005949 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005950
5951 if (lType->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005952 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005953 else
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005954 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005955 return ResultTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005956 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005957
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005958 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005959 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5960 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005961 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005962 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005963 }
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005964 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5965 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005966 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005967 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005968 }
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005969 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005970}
5971
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005972/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005973/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005974/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5975/// types.
5976QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005977 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005978 bool isRelational) {
5979 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5980 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005981 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005982 if (vType.isNull())
5983 return vType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005984
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005985 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5986 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005987
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005988 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5989 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5990 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005991 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005992 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5993 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5994 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005995 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5996 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5997 << 0 // self-
5998 << 2 // "a constant"
5999 );
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006000 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006001
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006002 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00006003 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
6004 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006005 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006006 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006007
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006008 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
6009 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
6010 // elements for floating point vectors.
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006011 if (lType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006012 return lType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006013
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006014 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006015 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00006016 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006017 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattnerd013aa12009-03-31 07:46:52 +00006018 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00006019 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
6020
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006021 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00006022 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006023 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
6024}
6025
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006026inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006027 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006028 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
6029 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
6030 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
6031 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
6032
6033 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
6034 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00006035
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00006036 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006037
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00006038 if (lex->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
6039 rex->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00006040 return compType;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006041 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006042}
6043
6044inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006045 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
6046
6047 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
6048 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
6049 // is a constant.
6050 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !lex->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
Eli Friedman787b0942010-07-27 19:14:53 +00006051 rex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !rex->isValueDependent() &&
Chris Lattner23ef3e42010-07-15 00:26:43 +00006052 // Don't warn in macros.
Chris Lattnerb7690b42010-07-24 01:10:11 +00006053 !Loc.isMacroID()) {
6054 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
6055 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
6056 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
6057 Expr::EvalResult Result;
6058 if (rex->Evaluate(Result, Context) && !Result.HasSideEffects &&
6059 Result.Val.getInt() != 0 && Result.Val.getInt() != 1) {
6060 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
6061 << rex->getSourceRange()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006062 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||")
6063 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|");
Chris Lattnerb7690b42010-07-24 01:10:11 +00006064 }
6065 }
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006066
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006067 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6068 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
6069 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006070
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006071 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
6072 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006073
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006074 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson04905012009-10-16 01:44:21 +00006075 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006076
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00006077 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
6078 // non-overloadable operands.
6079
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006080 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
6081 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00006082 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
6083 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
6084 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006085 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006086
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006087 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
6088 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
6089 // The result is a bool.
6090 return Context.BoolTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006091}
6092
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006093/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
6094/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
6095/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
6096///
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006097static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006098 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
6099 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
6100 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
Fariborz Jahanian8ac2d442010-10-14 16:04:05 +00006101 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->isSuperReceiver() ?
6102 PropExpr->getSuperType() :
6103 PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
6104
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006105 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006106 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
6107 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
6108 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
6109 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006110 }
6111 }
6112 return false;
6113}
6114
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006115/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
6116/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
6117static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006118 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006119 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006120 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006121 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
6122 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006123 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
6124 return false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006125
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006126 unsigned Diag = 0;
6127 bool NeedType = false;
6128 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006129 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006130 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006131 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6132 NeedType = true;
6133 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006134 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006135 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6136 NeedType = true;
6137 break;
Chris Lattnerca354fa2008-11-17 19:51:54 +00006138 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006139 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
6140 break;
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006141 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
6142 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006143 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006144 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
6145 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006146 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6147 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006148 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
6149 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregor86447ec2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00006150 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006151 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00006152 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006153 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006154 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
6155 break;
Steve Naroff4f6a7d72008-09-26 14:41:28 +00006156 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006157 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6158 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5daf5702008-11-22 18:39:36 +00006159 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
6160 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
6161 break;
Fariborz Jahanianba8d2d62008-11-22 20:25:50 +00006162 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
6163 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
6164 break;
Fariborz Jahanian2514a302009-12-15 23:59:41 +00006165 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
6166 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
6167 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006168 }
Steve Naroffd1861fd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00006169
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006170 SourceRange Assign;
6171 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
6172 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006173 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006174 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006175 else
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006176 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006177 return true;
6178}
6179
6180
6181
6182// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006183QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
6184 SourceLocation Loc,
6185 QualType CompoundType) {
6186 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
6187 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006188 return QualType();
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006189
6190 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
6191 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006192 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006193 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006194 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006195 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006196 ConvertPropertyAssignment(LHS, RHS, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006197 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006198 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
6199 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
6200 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006201 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006202 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006203 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006204 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006205
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006206 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
6207 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
6208 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006209 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006210 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
6211 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
6212 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006213 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ||
6214 UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) &&
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006215 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006216 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006217 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
6218 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
6219 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattner3e872092009-03-09 07:11:10 +00006220 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
6221 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006222 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006223 << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-")
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006224 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006225 }
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006226 }
6227 } else {
6228 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedman623712b2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00006229 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006230 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006231
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006232 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006233 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006234 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006235
Chris Lattner8b5dec32010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006236
6237 // Check to see if the destination operand is a dereferenced null pointer. If
6238 // so, and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
6239 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
6240 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
6241 // only handles the pattern "*null = whatever", which is a very syntactic
6242 // check.
6243 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()))
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006244 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref &&
Chris Lattner8b5dec32010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006245 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
6246 isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
6247 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
6248 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
6249 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange();
6250 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_indirection_through_null);
6251 }
6252
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006253 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
6254 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006255 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006256 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
6257 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006258 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006259 // operand.
John McCall2bf6f492010-10-12 02:19:57 +00006260 return (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6261 ? LHSType : LHSType.getUnqualifiedType());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006262}
6263
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006264// C99 6.5.17
6265QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis25973452010-06-30 10:53:14 +00006266 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
6267
Douglas Gregor7ad5d422010-11-09 21:07:58 +00006268 ExprResult LHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS, Loc);
6269 if (LHSResult.isInvalid())
6270 return QualType();
6271
6272 ExprResult RHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS, Loc);
6273 if (RHSResult.isInvalid())
6274 return QualType();
6275 RHS = RHSResult.take();
6276
John McCallcf2e5062010-10-12 07:14:40 +00006277 // C's comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1) on both its
6278 // operands, but not unary promotions.
6279 // C++'s comma does not do any conversions at all (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
6280 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6281 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS);
6282 if (!LHS->getType()->isVoidType())
6283 RequireCompleteType(Loc, LHS->getType(), diag::err_incomplete_type);
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006284
John McCallcf2e5062010-10-12 07:14:40 +00006285 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
6286 if (!RHS->getType()->isVoidType())
6287 RequireCompleteType(Loc, RHS->getType(), diag::err_incomplete_type);
6288 }
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006289
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006290 return RHS->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006291}
6292
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00006293/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
6294/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006295QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006296 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006297 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6298 return Context.DependentTy;
6299
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006300 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
6301 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006302
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006303 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
6304 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
6305 if (!isInc) {
6306 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6307 return QualType();
6308 }
6309 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
6310 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6311 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006312 // OK!
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006313 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
6314 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006315
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006316 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006317 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006318 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6319 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
6320 << Op->getSourceRange();
6321 return QualType();
6322 }
6323
6324 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006325 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006326 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006327 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6328 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
6329 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
6330 return QualType();
6331 }
6332
6333 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006334 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006335 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006336 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006337 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006338 << ResType))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00006339 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006340 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006341 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006342 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6343 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6344 return QualType();
6345 }
Eli Friedman5b088a12010-01-03 00:20:48 +00006346 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006347 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
6348 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006349 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006350 } else if (ResType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6351 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op, OpLoc);
6352 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6353 return CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(PR.take(), OpLoc, isInc, isPrefix);
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006354 } else {
6355 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006356 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006357 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006358 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006359 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroffdd10e022007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006360 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006361 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006362 return QualType();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006363 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
6364 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
6365 // operand.
6366 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6367 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006368}
6369
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006370void Sema::ConvertPropertyAssignment(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, QualType& LHSTy) {
6371 bool copyInit = false;
6372 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
6373 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
6374 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
6375 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
6376 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
6377 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
6378 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
6379 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
6380 }
6381 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHSTy->isRecordType());
6382 }
6383 else
6384 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(LHS) &&
6385 LHSTy->isRecordType());
6386 if (copyInit) {
6387 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006388 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006389 Expr *Arg = RHS;
6390 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(),
6391 Owned(Arg));
6392 if (!ArgE.isInvalid())
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006393 RHS = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006394 }
6395}
6396
6397
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006398/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006399/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006400/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6401/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6402/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6403/// - &(x) => x
6404/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6405/// - &s.xx => s
6406/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6407/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6408/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6409/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006410static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006411 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006412 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006413 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006414 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006415 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6416 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6417 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006418 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006419 return 0;
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006420 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006421 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006422 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006423 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6424 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006425 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6426 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6427 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6428 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6429 }
6430 return 0;
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006431 }
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006432 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6433 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006434
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006435 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006436 case UO_Real:
6437 case UO_Imag:
6438 case UO_Extension:
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006439 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6440 default:
6441 return 0;
6442 }
6443 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006444 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006445 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006446 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006447 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6448 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006449 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006450 default:
6451 return 0;
6452 }
6453}
6454
6455/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006456/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006457/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006458/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006459/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006460/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006461/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006462QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
6463 if (OrigOp->isTypeDependent())
Douglas Gregor9103bb22008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006464 return Context.DependentTy;
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006465 if (OrigOp->getType() == Context.OverloadTy)
6466 return Context.OverloadTy;
6467
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006468 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(OrigOp, OpLoc);
6469 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6470 OrigOp = PR.take();
6471
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006472 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6473 Expr *op = OrigOp->IgnoreParens();
Douglas Gregor9103bb22008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006474
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006475 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6476 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6477 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006478 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref)
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006479 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6480 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6481 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6482 }
6483 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6484 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6485 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006486 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner28be73f2008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006487 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes6b6609f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006488
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006489 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006490 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6491 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6492 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6493 if (isSFINAEContext())
6494 return QualType();
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006495 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) {
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006496 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006497 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) {
6498 // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer.
6499 // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo.
6500
6501 // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up.
6502 if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) {
6503 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
6504 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6505 return QualType();
6506 }
6507 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op);
6508 CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
6509
6510 // The id-expression was parenthesized.
6511 if (OrigOp != DRE) {
6512 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function)
6513 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6514
6515 // The method was named without a qualifier.
6516 } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) {
6517 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6518 << op->getSourceRange();
6519 }
6520
6521 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6522 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6523 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006524 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006525 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006526 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006527 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006528 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6529 << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006530 return QualType();
6531 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006532 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006533 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6534 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6535 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006536 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson09380262010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006537 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006538 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006539 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemanb104b1f2009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006540 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006541 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian0337f212009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006542 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6543 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6544 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6545 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6546 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson1d524c32009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006547 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6548 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson474e1022009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006549 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6550 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006551 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006552 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006553 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6554 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4020f872010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006555 // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register
6556 // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3)
John McCalld931b082010-08-26 03:08:43 +00006557 if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register &&
Fariborz Jahanian4020f872010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006558 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006559 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6560 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006561 return QualType();
6562 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006563 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006564 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006565 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor29882052008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006566 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006567 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6568 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006569 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006570 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006571 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6572 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006573 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006574 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6575 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6576 return QualType();
6577 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006578
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006579 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6580 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006581 }
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006582 }
Anders Carlsson196f7d02009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006583 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006584 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006585 }
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006586
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006587 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6588 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6589 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6590 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6591 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6592 }
6593
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006594 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Douglas Gregor8f70ddb2010-07-29 16:05:45 +00006595 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
6596 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006597 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
6598}
6599
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006600/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006601QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006602 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6603 return Context.DependentTy;
6604
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006605 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006606 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
6607 QualType Result;
6608
6609 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
6610 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
6611 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
6612 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
6613 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6614 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
6615 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
6616 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6617 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006618 else {
6619 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op, OpLoc);
6620 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6621 if (PR.take() != Op) return CheckIndirectionOperand(PR.take(), OpLoc);
6622 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006623
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006624 if (Result.isNull()) {
6625 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
6626 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6627 return QualType();
6628 }
6629
6630 return Result;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006631}
6632
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006633static inline BinaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006634 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006635 BinaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006636 switch (Kind) {
6637 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006638 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break;
6639 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break;
6640 case tok::star: Opc = BO_Mul; break;
6641 case tok::slash: Opc = BO_Div; break;
6642 case tok::percent: Opc = BO_Rem; break;
6643 case tok::plus: Opc = BO_Add; break;
6644 case tok::minus: Opc = BO_Sub; break;
6645 case tok::lessless: Opc = BO_Shl; break;
6646 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BO_Shr; break;
6647 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BO_LE; break;
6648 case tok::less: Opc = BO_LT; break;
6649 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BO_GE; break;
6650 case tok::greater: Opc = BO_GT; break;
6651 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BO_NE; break;
6652 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BO_EQ; break;
6653 case tok::amp: Opc = BO_And; break;
6654 case tok::caret: Opc = BO_Xor; break;
6655 case tok::pipe: Opc = BO_Or; break;
6656 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BO_LAnd; break;
6657 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BO_LOr; break;
6658 case tok::equal: Opc = BO_Assign; break;
6659 case tok::starequal: Opc = BO_MulAssign; break;
6660 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BO_DivAssign; break;
6661 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BO_RemAssign; break;
6662 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BO_AddAssign; break;
6663 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BO_SubAssign; break;
6664 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break;
6665 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break;
6666 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BO_AndAssign; break;
6667 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BO_XorAssign; break;
6668 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BO_OrAssign; break;
6669 case tok::comma: Opc = BO_Comma; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006670 }
6671 return Opc;
6672}
6673
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006674static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006675 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006676 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006677 switch (Kind) {
6678 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006679 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PreInc; break;
6680 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PreDec; break;
6681 case tok::amp: Opc = UO_AddrOf; break;
6682 case tok::star: Opc = UO_Deref; break;
6683 case tok::plus: Opc = UO_Plus; break;
6684 case tok::minus: Opc = UO_Minus; break;
6685 case tok::tilde: Opc = UO_Not; break;
6686 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UO_LNot; break;
6687 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UO_Real; break;
6688 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UO_Imag; break;
6689 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006690 }
6691 return Opc;
6692}
6693
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006694/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6695/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6696/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006697ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006698 unsigned Op,
6699 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006700 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006701 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) Op;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006702 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6703 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6704 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006705
6706 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006707 case BO_Assign:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006708 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6709 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006710 case BO_PtrMemD:
6711 case BO_PtrMemI:
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006712 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006713 Opc == BO_PtrMemI);
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006714 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006715 case BO_Mul:
6716 case BO_Div:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006717 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006718 Opc == BO_Div);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006719 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006720 case BO_Rem:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006721 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6722 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006723 case BO_Add:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006724 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6725 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006726 case BO_Sub:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006727 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6728 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006729 case BO_Shl:
6730 case BO_Shr:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006731 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6732 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006733 case BO_LE:
6734 case BO_LT:
6735 case BO_GE:
6736 case BO_GT:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006737 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006738 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006739 case BO_EQ:
6740 case BO_NE:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006741 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006742 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006743 case BO_And:
6744 case BO_Xor:
6745 case BO_Or:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006746 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6747 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006748 case BO_LAnd:
6749 case BO_LOr:
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006750 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006751 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006752 case BO_MulAssign:
6753 case BO_DivAssign:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006754 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006755 Opc == BO_DivAssign);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006756 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6757 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6758 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006759 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006760 case BO_RemAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006761 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6762 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6763 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6764 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006765 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006766 case BO_AddAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006767 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6768 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6769 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006770 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006771 case BO_SubAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006772 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6773 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6774 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006775 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006776 case BO_ShlAssign:
6777 case BO_ShrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006778 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6779 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6780 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6781 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006782 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006783 case BO_AndAssign:
6784 case BO_XorAssign:
6785 case BO_OrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006786 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6787 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6788 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6789 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006790 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006791 case BO_Comma:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006792 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6793 break;
6794 }
6795 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006796 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian57dae1a2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006797 if (ResultTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006798 if (Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign)
Fariborz Jahanian57dae1a2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006799 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_assignment_requires_nonfragile_object)
6800 << ResultTy;
6801 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006802 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006803 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6804 else
6805 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006806 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6807 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006808}
6809
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006810/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6811/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006812static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6813 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006814 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6815 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6816 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006817 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006818 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6819
6820 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6821 return;
6822
6823 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6824 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6825 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006826 return;
6827 }
6828
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006829 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6830 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006831 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006832
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006833 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006834 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006835
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006836 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6837 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6838 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6839 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006840 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006841 return;
6842 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006843
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006844 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006845 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6846 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006847}
6848
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006849/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6850/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6851/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6852/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006853static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006854 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006855 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6856 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6857 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6858 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006859 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006860 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006861 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6862
6863 // Subs are not binary operators.
6864 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6865 return;
6866
6867 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6868 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006869 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6870 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006871 return;
6872
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006873 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006874 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006875 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006876 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6877 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006878 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006879 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006880 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6881 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6882 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6883 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006884 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006885 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006886 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006887 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6888 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006889 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006890 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006891 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6892 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6893 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6894 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006895}
6896
6897/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6898/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6899/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006900static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006901 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006902 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006903 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6904}
6905
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006906// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006907ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006908 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6909 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
6910 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006911 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6912 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006913
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006914 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6915 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6916
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006917 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6918}
6919
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006920ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006921 BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
6922 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006923 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006924 ((!isa<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(lhs) &&
6925 !isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(lhs))
Fariborz Jahanianeb17e8b2010-09-17 20:45:45 +00006926 || rhs->isTypeDependent() || Opc != BO_Assign) &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006927 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006928 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6929 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6930 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6931 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6932 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006933 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006934 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006935 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6936 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6937 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006938
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006939 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6940 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006941 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006942 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006943
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006944 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006945 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006946}
6947
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006948ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006949 unsigned OpcIn,
6950 Expr *Input) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006951 UnaryOperatorKind Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperatorKind>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006952
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006953 QualType resultType;
6954 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006955 case UO_PreInc:
6956 case UO_PreDec:
6957 case UO_PostInc:
6958 case UO_PostDec:
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006959 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006960 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6961 Opc == UO_PostInc,
6962 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6963 Opc == UO_PreDec);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006964 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006965 case UO_AddrOf:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006966 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6967 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006968 case UO_Deref:
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006969 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006970 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6971 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006972 case UO_Plus:
6973 case UO_Minus:
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006974 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6975 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006976 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6977 break;
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00006978 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6979 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006980 break;
6981 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6982 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6983 break;
6984 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006985 Opc == UO_Plus &&
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006986 resultType->isPointerType())
6987 break;
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006988 else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6989 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
6990 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
6991 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
6992 }
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006993
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006994 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6995 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006996 case UO_Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006997 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6998 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006999 if (resultType->isDependentType())
7000 break;
Chris Lattner02a65142008-07-25 23:52:49 +00007001 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
7002 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
7003 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00007004 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00007005 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007006 else if (resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
7007 break;
7008 else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
7009 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
7010 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
7011 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
7012 } else {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007013 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
7014 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007015 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007016 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007017 case UO_LNot: // logical negation
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007018 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007019 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00007020 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007021 if (resultType->isDependentType())
7022 break;
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007023 if (resultType->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.3.3p1
7024 // ok, fallthrough
7025 } else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
7026 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
7027 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
7028 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
7029 } else {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007030 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
7031 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007032 }
Douglas Gregorea844f32010-09-20 17:13:33 +00007033
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007034 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007035 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
7036 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007037 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007038 case UO_Real:
7039 case UO_Imag:
7040 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real);
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00007041 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007042 case UO_Extension:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007043 resultType = Input->getType();
7044 break;
7045 }
7046 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007047 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007048
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00007049 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007050}
7051
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007052ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007053 UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
7054 Expr *Input) {
Anders Carlssona8a1e3d2009-11-14 21:26:41 +00007055 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
Eli Friedman957c0942010-09-05 23:15:52 +00007056 UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc) != OO_None) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007057 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
7058 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
7059 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
7060 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007061 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007062 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007063 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
7064 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
7065 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007066
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007067 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007068 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007069
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007070 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007071}
7072
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007073// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007074ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007075 tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) {
7076 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input);
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007077}
7078
Steve Naroff1b273c42007-09-16 14:56:35 +00007079/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007080ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007081 SourceLocation LabLoc,
7082 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007083 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007084 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getCurFunction()->LabelMap[LabelII];
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007085
Daniel Dunbar0ffb1252008-08-04 16:51:22 +00007086 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
7087 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroffcaaacec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00007088 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00007089 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007090
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007091 LabelDecl->setUsed();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007092 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007093 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
7094 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007095}
7096
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007097ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007098Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007099 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007100 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
7101 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
7102
Douglas Gregordd8f5692010-03-10 04:54:39 +00007103 bool isFileScope
7104 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattner4a049f02009-04-25 19:11:05 +00007105 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007106 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedmandca2b732009-01-24 23:09:00 +00007107
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007108 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
7109 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
7110 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007111
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007112 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
7113 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
7114 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007115 bool StmtExprMayBindToTemp = false;
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007116 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
7117 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007118 LabelStmt *LastLabelStmt = 0;
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007119 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007120 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt)) {
7121 LastLabelStmt = Label;
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007122 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007123 }
7124 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4bdc4462010-10-27 20:44:00 +00007125 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LastExpr);
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007126 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007127 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && !LastExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
7128 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
7129 InitializedEntity::InitializeResult(LPLoc,
7130 Ty,
7131 false),
7132 SourceLocation(),
7133 Owned(LastExpr));
7134 if (Res.isInvalid())
7135 return ExprError();
7136 if ((LastExpr = Res.takeAs<Expr>())) {
7137 if (!LastLabelStmt)
7138 Compound->setLastStmt(LastExpr);
7139 else
7140 LastLabelStmt->setSubStmt(LastExpr);
7141 StmtExprMayBindToTemp = true;
7142 }
7143 }
7144 }
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007145 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007146
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007147 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
7148 // expressions are not lvalues.
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007149 Expr *ResStmtExpr = new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc);
7150 if (StmtExprMayBindToTemp)
7151 return MaybeBindToTemporary(ResStmtExpr);
7152 return Owned(ResStmtExpr);
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007153}
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007154
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007155ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007156 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
7157 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7158 unsigned NumComponents,
7159 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007160 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007161 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnarabd054db2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00007162 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007163
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007164 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
7165 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
7166 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007167 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007168 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
7169 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
7170
7171 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
7172 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
7173 if (!Dependent
7174 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
7175 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
7176 << TypeRange))
7177 return ExprError();
7178
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00007179 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
7180 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00007181 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
7182 // a system header!
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00007183 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00007184 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
7185 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007186
7187 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
7188 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
7189 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
7190 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
7191 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
7192 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
7193 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
7194 if (OC.isBrackets) {
7195 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
7196 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7197 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
7198 if(!AT)
7199 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
7200 << CurrentType);
7201 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
7202 } else
7203 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7204
7205 // The expression must be an integral expression.
7206 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
7207 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
7208 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
7209 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
7210 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
7211 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
7212 << Idx->getSourceRange());
7213
7214 // Record this array index.
7215 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
7216 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
7217 continue;
7218 }
7219
7220 // Offset of a field.
7221 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7222 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
7223 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
7224 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
7225 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7226 continue;
7227 }
7228
7229 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
7230 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
7231 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
7232 return ExprError();
7233
7234 // Look for the designated field.
7235 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
7236 if (!RC)
7237 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
7238 << CurrentType);
7239 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
7240
7241 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
7242 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
7243 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
7244 // (clause 9).
7245 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
7246 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
7247 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
7248 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
7249 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
7250 << CurrentType))
7251 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
7252 }
7253
7254 // Look for the field.
7255 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
7256 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
7257 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
7258 if (!MemberDecl)
7259 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
7260 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
7261 OC.LocEnd));
7262
Douglas Gregor9d5d60f2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00007263 // C99 7.17p3:
7264 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
7265 //
7266 // We diagnose this as an error.
7267 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
7268 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
7269 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
7270 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
7271 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
7272 return ExprError();
7273 }
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007274
7275 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
7276 bool AnonStructUnion = Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion();
7277 if (AnonStructUnion) {
7278 do {
7279 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(Parent->getParent());
7280 } while (Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
7281 }
7282
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007283 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
7284 // the base class indirections.
7285 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
7286 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007287 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007288 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
7289 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
7290 B != BEnd; ++B)
7291 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
7292 }
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007293
7294 if (AnonStructUnion) {
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007295 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
7296 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
7297 unsigned n = Path.size();
7298 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
7299 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
7300 } else {
7301 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
7302 }
7303 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
7304 }
7305
7306 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
7307 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
7308 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
7309}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007310
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007311ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007312 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7313 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
7314 ParsedType argty,
7315 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7316 unsigned NumComponents,
7317 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7318
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007319 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
7320 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
7321 if (ArgTy.isNull())
7322 return ExprError();
7323
Eli Friedman5a15dc12010-08-05 10:15:45 +00007324 if (!ArgTInfo)
7325 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
7326
7327 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
7328 RPLoc);
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007329}
7330
7331
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007332ExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007333 ParsedType arg1, ParsedType arg2,
7334 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007335 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1;
7336 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1, &argTInfo1);
7337 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2;
7338 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2, &argTInfo2);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007339
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007340 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007341
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007342 return BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(BuiltinLoc, argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc);
7343}
7344
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007345ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007346Sema::BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7347 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1,
7348 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2,
7349 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Douglas Gregorc12a9c52009-05-19 22:28:02 +00007350 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7351 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
7352 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7353 return ExprError();
7354 }
7355
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007356 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007357 argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007358}
7359
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007360
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007361ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007362 Expr *CondExpr,
7363 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
7364 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007365 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
7366
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007367 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007368 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregorc9ecc572009-05-19 22:43:30 +00007369 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007370 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007371 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007372 } else {
7373 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7374 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7375 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7376 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007377 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7378 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7379 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007380
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007381 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7382 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007383 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7384 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007385 }
7386
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007387 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007388 resType, RPLoc,
7389 resType->isDependentType(),
7390 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007391}
7392
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007393//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7394// Clang Extensions.
7395//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7396
7397/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007398void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007399 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7400 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7401 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007402 if (BlockScope)
7403 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
7404 else
7405 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007406}
7407
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007408void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007409 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007410 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007411
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007412 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007413 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007414 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007415
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007416 bool isVariadic;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007417 QualType RetTy;
7418 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007419 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007420 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007421 isVariadic =
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007422 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7423 } else {
7424 RetTy = T;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007425 isVariadic = false;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007426 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007427
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007428 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007429
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007430 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7431 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7432 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007433 return;
7434 }
7435
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007436 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7437 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7438 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7439 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7440 return;
7441 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007442
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007443 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007444 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7445 // ^ * { ... }
7446 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007447 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7448 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007449
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007450 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007451 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007452 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7453 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7454 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7455 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007456 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7457 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7458 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7459 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7460 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007461 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007462 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007463
7464 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7465 // ^ fntype { ... }
7466 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7467 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7468 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7469 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7470 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7471 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7472 *I);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007473 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007474 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007475 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007476
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007477 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
Douglas Gregor82aa7132010-11-01 18:37:59 +00007478 if (!Params.empty()) {
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007479 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
Douglas Gregor82aa7132010-11-01 18:37:59 +00007480 CheckParmsForFunctionDef(CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7481 CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(),
7482 /*CheckParameterNames=*/false);
7483 }
7484
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007485 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor9cdda0c2009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007486 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007487
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007488 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007489 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7490 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7491 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7492 }
7493
7494 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7495 // if we don't have any.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007496 if (Params.empty())
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007497 return;
7498
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007499 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7500 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7501
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007502 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007503 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7504 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7505
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007506 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007507 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7508 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7509 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7510
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007511 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007512 }
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007513 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007514}
7515
7516/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7517/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7518void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007519 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner5c59e2b2009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007520 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007521 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007522}
7523
7524/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7525/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007526ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007527 Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9af55002009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007528 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7529 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7530 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007531
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007532 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007533
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007534 PopDeclContext();
7535
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007536 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007537 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7538 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007539
Mike Stump56925862009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007540 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007541 QualType BlockTy;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007542
7543 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7544 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7545 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7546
7547 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7548 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7549
7550 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7551 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7552 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7553 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7554
7555 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7556 // preserve its sugar structure.
7557 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7558 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7559 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7560
7561 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7562 } else {
7563 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7564 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7565 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7566 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7567 FPT->isVariadic(),
7568 /*quals*/ 0,
7569 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7570 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7571 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7572 FPT->exception_begin(),
7573 Ext);
7574 }
7575
7576 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7577 } else {
7578 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7579 false, false, 0, 0,
7580 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7581 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007582
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007583 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7584 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007585 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007586
Chris Lattner17a78302009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007587 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007588 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007589 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007590
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007591 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007592
7593 bool Good = true;
7594 // Check goto/label use.
7595 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7596 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7597 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7598
7599 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7600 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007601 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0) {
7602 if (!L->isUsed())
7603 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::warn_unused_label) << L->getName();
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007604 continue;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007605 }
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007606
7607 // Emit error.
7608 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7609 Good = false;
7610 }
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007611 if (!Good) {
7612 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007613 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007614 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007615
John McCalle0054f62010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007616 BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7617 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
7618
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007619 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenekd064fdc2010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007620 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7621 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
John McCalle0054f62010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007622 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, Result);
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007623
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007624 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007625 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007626}
7627
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007628ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007629 Expr *expr, ParsedType type,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007630 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007631 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
7632 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type, &TInfo);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007633 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, expr, TInfo, RPLoc);
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007634}
7635
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007636ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007637 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007638 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007639 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007640
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007641 // Get the va_list type
7642 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007643 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7644 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7645 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7646 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007647 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007648 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7649 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7650 } else {
7651 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7652 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007653 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007654 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007655 return ExprError();
7656 }
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007657
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007658 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7659 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007660 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7661 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007662 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9dc8f192009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007663 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007664
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007665 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007666 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007667
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007668 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7669 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T));
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007670}
7671
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007672ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007673 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7674 // pointers on the target.
7675 QualType Ty;
7676 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7677 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7678 else
7679 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7680
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007681 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007682}
7683
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007684static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007685 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007686 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7687 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007688
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007689 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7690 if (!PT)
7691 return;
7692
7693 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7694 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7695 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7696 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7697 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7698 return;
7699 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007700
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007701 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7702 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7703 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7704 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007705
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007706 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007707}
7708
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007709bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7710 SourceLocation Loc,
7711 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007712 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7713 bool *Complained) {
7714 if (Complained)
7715 *Complained = false;
7716
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007717 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7718 bool isInvalid = false;
7719 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007720 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007721
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007722 switch (ConvTy) {
7723 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7724 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007725 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007726 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7727 break;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007728 case IntToPointer:
7729 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7730 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007731 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007732 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007733 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7734 break;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007735 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7736 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7737 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007738 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7739 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7740 break;
7741 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007742 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7743 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7744 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7745 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7746 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7747 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7748 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7749 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7750 // C++ semantics.
7751 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7752 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7753 return false;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007754 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7755 break;
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007756 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanian3451e922009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007757 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007758 break;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007759 case IntToBlockPointer:
7760 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7761 break;
7762 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stump25efa102009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007763 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007764 break;
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007765 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007766 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007767 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7768 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7769 break;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007770 case IncompatibleVectors:
7771 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7772 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007773 case Incompatible:
7774 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7775 isInvalid = true;
7776 break;
7777 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007778
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007779 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7780 switch (Action) {
7781 case AA_Assigning:
7782 case AA_Initializing:
7783 // The destination type comes first.
7784 FirstType = DstType;
7785 SecondType = SrcType;
7786 break;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007787
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007788 case AA_Returning:
7789 case AA_Passing:
7790 case AA_Converting:
7791 case AA_Sending:
7792 case AA_Casting:
7793 // The source type comes first.
7794 FirstType = SrcType;
7795 SecondType = DstType;
7796 break;
7797 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007798
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007799 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007800 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007801 if (Complained)
7802 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007803 return isInvalid;
7804}
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007805
Chris Lattner3bf68932009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007806bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007807 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7808 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7809 if (Result)
7810 *Result = ICEResult;
7811 return false;
7812 }
7813
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007814 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7815
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007816 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007817 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7818 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7819
7820 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7821 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7822 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7823 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7824 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7825 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7826 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007827
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007828 return true;
7829 }
7830
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007831 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7832 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007833
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007834 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7835 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7836 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007837
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007838 if (Result)
7839 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7840 return false;
7841}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007842
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007843void
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007844Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007845 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7846 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007847}
7848
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007849void
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007850Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7851 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7852 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7853 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007854
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007855 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7856 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7857 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7858 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7859 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007860 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007861 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7862 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7863 I != IEnd; ++I)
7864 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7865 }
7866
7867 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7868 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7869 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7870 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7871 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7872 I != IEnd; ++I)
7873 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7874 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007875 }
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007876
7877 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7878 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7879 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7880 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007881 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007882 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7883 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7884 ExprTemporaries.end());
7885
7886 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7887 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007888}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007889
7890/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7891///
7892/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7893/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7894/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7895/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7896///
7897/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7898///
7899/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7900void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7901 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007902
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007903 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007904 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007905
Douglas Gregorb5352cf2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007906 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7907 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7908 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7909 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007910 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007911 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Anders Carlsson2127ecc2010-10-22 23:37:08 +00007912 D->setUsed();
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007913 return;
7914 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007915
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007916 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7917 return;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007918
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007919 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7920 // an instantiation.
7921 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7922 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007923
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007924 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007925 case Unevaluated:
7926 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7927 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007928
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007929 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7930 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7931 // "used"; handle this below.
7932 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007933
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007934 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7935 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7936 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7937 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007938 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007939 return;
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007940
7941 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
7942 // Referenced declarations will only be used if the construct in the
7943 // containing expression is used.
7944 return;
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007945 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007946
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007947 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanianb7f4cc02009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007948 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007949 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian05a5c452009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007950 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Chandler Carruth4e6fbce2010-08-23 07:55:51 +00007951 if (Constructor->getParent()->hasTrivialConstructor())
7952 return;
7953 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
7954 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007955 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor9e9199d2009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007956 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007957 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007958 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7959 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007960
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007961 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007962 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007963 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007964 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007965 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7966 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007967 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7968 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7969 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007970 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor39957dc2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007971 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007972 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7973 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007974 }
Fariborz Jahanianf5ed9e02009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007975 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007976 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor1637be72009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007977 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor6cfacfe2010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007978 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007979 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7980 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7981 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7982 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7983 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007984 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007985 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007986 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007987 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007988 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7989 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7990 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007991 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007992 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007993 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7994 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007995
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007996 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7997 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7998 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7999 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
8000 Loc));
8001 else
Chandler Carruth62c78d52010-08-25 08:44:16 +00008002 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function, Loc));
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00008003 }
Gabor Greif40181c42010-08-28 00:16:06 +00008004 } else // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable.
8005 for (FunctionDecl::redecl_iterator i(Function->redecls_begin()),
8006 e(Function->redecls_end()); i != e; ++i) {
Gabor Greifbe9ebe32010-08-28 01:58:12 +00008007 if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable())
Gabor Greif40181c42010-08-28 00:16:06 +00008008 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *i);
8009 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008010
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008011 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Argyrios Kyrtzidis58b52592010-08-25 10:34:54 +00008012
8013 // Recursive functions should be marked when used from another function.
8014 if (CurContext != Function)
8015 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008016
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008017 return;
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00008018 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008019
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008020 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00008021 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008022 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00008023 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
8024 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
8025 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
8026 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
8027 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
8028 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Chandler Carruth62c78d52010-08-25 08:44:16 +00008029 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00008030 }
8031 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008032
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008033 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00008034
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008035 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00008036 return;
Sam Weinigcce6ebc2009-09-11 03:29:30 +00008037 }
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008038}
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008039
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008040namespace {
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008041 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008042 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008043 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008044 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
8045 Sema &S;
8046 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008047
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008048 public:
8049 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008050
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008051 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008052
8053 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
8054 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008055 };
8056}
8057
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008058bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
8059 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008060 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
8061 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
8062 }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008063
8064 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008065}
8066
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008067bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008068 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
8069 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
8070 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Douglas Gregor910f8002010-11-07 23:05:16 +00008071 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.data(), Args.size());
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008072 }
8073
Chandler Carruthe3e210c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00008074 return true;
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008075}
8076
8077void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
8078 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008079 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008080}
8081
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008082namespace {
8083 /// \brief Helper class that marks all of the declarations referenced by
8084 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
8085 class EvaluatedExprMarker : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> {
8086 Sema &S;
8087
8088 public:
8089 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> Inherited;
8090
8091 explicit EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema &S) : Inherited(S.Context), S(S) { }
8092
8093 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
8094 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
8095 }
8096
8097 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
8098 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getMemberLoc(), E->getMemberDecl());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008099 Inherited::VisitMemberExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008100 }
8101
8102 void VisitCXXNewExpr(CXXNewExpr *E) {
8103 if (E->getConstructor())
8104 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
8105 if (E->getOperatorNew())
8106 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorNew());
8107 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
8108 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008109 Inherited::VisitCXXNewExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008110 }
8111
8112 void VisitCXXDeleteExpr(CXXDeleteExpr *E) {
8113 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
8114 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor5833b0b2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00008115 QualType Destroyed = S.Context.getBaseElementType(E->getDestroyedType());
8116 if (const RecordType *DestroyedRec = Destroyed->getAs<RecordType>()) {
8117 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DestroyedRec->getDecl());
8118 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(),
8119 S.LookupDestructor(Record));
8120 }
8121
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008122 Inherited::VisitCXXDeleteExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008123 }
8124
8125 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) {
8126 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008127 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008128 }
8129
8130 void VisitBlockDeclRefExpr(BlockDeclRefExpr *E) {
8131 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
8132 }
Douglas Gregor102ff972010-10-19 17:17:35 +00008133
8134 void VisitCXXDefaultArgExpr(CXXDefaultArgExpr *E) {
8135 Visit(E->getExpr());
8136 }
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008137 };
8138}
8139
8140/// \brief Mark any declarations that appear within this expression or any
8141/// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
8142void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr *E) {
8143 EvaluatedExprMarker(*this).Visit(E);
8144}
8145
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008146/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
8147/// of the program being compiled.
8148///
8149/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008150/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008151/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
8152/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
8153/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
8154/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008155/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008156/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008157///
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008158/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
8159/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
8160/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
8161/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008162bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008163 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
8164 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
8165 case Unevaluated:
8166 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
8167 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008168
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008169 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008170 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008171 Diag(Loc, PD);
8172 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008173
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008174 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
8175 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
8176 break;
8177 }
8178
8179 return false;
8180}
8181
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008182bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
8183 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
8184 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
8185 return false;
8186
8187 PartialDiagnostic Note =
8188 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
8189 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
8190 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008191
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008192 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008193 FD ?
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008194 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
8195 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008196 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008197 << CE->getSourceRange(),
8198 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
8199 return true;
8200
8201 return false;
8202}
8203
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008204// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
8205// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
8206void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
8207 SourceLocation Loc;
8208
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008209 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
8210
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008211 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
8212 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008213 if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign)
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008214 return;
8215
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008216 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
8217 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
8218 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
8219 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
8220
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008221 // self = [<foo> init...]
8222 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
8223 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
8224 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8225
8226 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
8227 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
8228 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
8229 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8230 }
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008231
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008232 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8233 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
8234 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
8235 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
8236 return;
8237
8238 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8239 } else {
8240 // Not an assignment.
8241 return;
8242 }
8243
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008244 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCall2d152152009-10-12 22:25:59 +00008245 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008246
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008247 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00008248 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008249 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008250 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
8251 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
8252 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008253}
8254
8255bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8256 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
8257
8258 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis11ab7902010-11-01 18:49:26 +00008259 if (E->isBoundMemberFunction(Context))
8260 return Diag(E->getLocStart(), diag::err_invalid_use_of_bound_member_func)
8261 << E->getSourceRange();
8262
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00008263 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008264
8265 QualType T = E->getType();
8266
8267 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
8268 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
8269 return true;
8270 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
8271 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
8272 << T << E->getSourceRange();
8273 return true;
8274 }
8275 }
8276
8277 return false;
8278}
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008279
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008280ExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
8281 Expr *Sub) {
Douglas Gregoreecf38f2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00008282 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008283 return ExprError();
8284
Douglas Gregorff331c12010-07-25 18:17:45 +00008285 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc))
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008286 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008287
8288 return Owned(Sub);
8289}
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00008290
8291/// Check for operands with placeholder types and complain if found.
8292/// Returns true if there was an error and no recovery was possible.
8293ExprResult Sema::CheckPlaceholderExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8294 const BuiltinType *BT = E->getType()->getAs<BuiltinType>();
8295 if (!BT || !BT->isPlaceholderType()) return Owned(E);
8296
8297 // If this is overload, check for a single overload.
8298 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) {
8299 if (FunctionDecl *Specialization
8300 = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(E)) {
8301 // The access doesn't really matter in this case.
8302 DeclAccessPair Found = DeclAccessPair::make(Specialization,
8303 Specialization->getAccess());
8304 E = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E, Found, Specialization);
8305 if (!E) return ExprError();
8306 return Owned(E);
8307 }
8308
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00008309 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ovl_unresolvable) << E->getSourceRange();
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00008310 return ExprError();
8311 }
8312
8313 // Otherwise it's a use of undeduced auto.
8314 assert(BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::UndeducedAuto);
8315
8316 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParens());
8317 Diag(Loc, diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
8318 << DRE->getDecl() << E->getSourceRange();
8319 return ExprError();
8320}